]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
tree.c (build_common_tree_nodes_2): Merge with build_common_tree_nodes.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
58cd1d70 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
38f8b050
JR
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
38f8b050
JR
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
38f8b050
JR
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
391A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
392directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
393removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
394@end defmac
395
c49a6962
JM
396@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
397
38f8b050
JR
398@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
399Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
400string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
401target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
402@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
403
404Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
405the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
407@xref{Target Fragment}.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
411Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
412a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
413indicates an absolute file name.
414@end defmac
415
416@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
417If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
418@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
419when the compiler is built as a cross
420compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
421to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
425Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
426standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
427try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
428@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
429is built as a cross compiler.
430@end defmac
431
432@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
433Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
435when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
437is built as a cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
443default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
445is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
449If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
451compiler is built as a cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
455If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
456standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
457cross compiler.
458@end defmac
459
460@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
462variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
463loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
464initialize the necessary environment variables.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
471comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
472
473Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474replacement.
475@end defmac
476
477@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
478Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
479system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
480directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
481@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
482
483Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
484specified.
485@end defmac
486
487@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
488Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
489standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
490try when searching for header files.
491
492Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
493@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
494@end defmac
495
496@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
497The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
498See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
499If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
500@end defmac
501
502@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
503Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
504for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
505usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
506@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
507@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
508and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
509and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
510@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
511
512The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
513Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
514string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
515for C++-only directories,
516and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
517wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
518the array with a null element.
519
520The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
521if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
522or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
523operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
524
525For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
526
527@smallexample
528#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
529@{ \
530 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
531 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
532 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
533 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
534 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
535@}
536@end smallexample
537@end defmac
538
539Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
540
541@enumerate
542@item
543Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
544
545@item
546The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 547is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
38f8b050
JR
548@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
549
550@item
551The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
552
553@item
554The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 555in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
38f8b050
JR
556
557@item
ff2ce160 558The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
559
560@item
ff2ce160 561The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
562
563@item
ff2ce160 564The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
565compiler.
566@end enumerate
567
568Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
569
570@enumerate
571@item
572Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
573
574@item
575The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
576value based on the installed toolchain location.
577
578@item
579The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
580(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
581
582@item
583The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 584in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
585
586@item
587The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
588
589@item
ff2ce160 590The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
591compiler.
592
593@item
ff2ce160 594The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
595native compiler, or we have a target system root.
596
597@item
ff2ce160 598The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
599native compiler, or we have a target system root.
600
601@item
602The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
603If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
604the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
605
606@item
607The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
608compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
609@file{/lib/}.
610
611@item
612The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
613compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
614@file{/usr/lib/}.
615@end enumerate
616
617@node Run-time Target
618@section Run-time Target Specification
619@cindex run-time target specification
620@cindex predefined macros
621@cindex target specifications
622
623@c prevent bad page break with this line
624Here are run-time target specifications.
625
626@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
627This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
628built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
629the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
630@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
631calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
632finished command line option processing your code can use those
633results freely.
634
635@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
636command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
637the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
638accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
639
640@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
641object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
642@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
643defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
644with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
645only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
646example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
647and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
648@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
649defines only @code{_ABI64}.
650
651You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
652@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
653or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
654assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
655macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
656to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
657variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
658@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
659preprocessing.
660@end defmac
661
662@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
663Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
664and is used for the target operating system instead.
665@end defmac
666
667@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
668Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
669and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
670macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
671it yourself.
672@end defmac
673
674@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
675This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
676any target-specific headers.
677@end deftypevar
678
679@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
680This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
681Its default setting is 0.
682@end deftypevr
683
684@cindex optional hardware or system features
685@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
686
687@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
688This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
689target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
690(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
691processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
692definition does nothing but return true.
693
96e45421
JM
694@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
695@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
696storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
697option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
698via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
699@end deftypefn
700
701@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
702This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
703target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
704definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
705option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
706valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
707default definition does nothing but return false.
708
709In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
710options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
711only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
712should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
713@end deftypefn
714
91ebb981
IS
715@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
716
717@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
718
719@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 720
38f8b050
JR
721@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
722This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
723but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
724pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
725attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
726when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
727actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
728@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
729@end deftypefn
730
731@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
732This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
733but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
734language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
735used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
736frontends.
737@end defmac
738
3020190e 739@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 740Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
741various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
742options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
743options are processed once
38f8b050 744just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 745of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 746options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 747
3020190e 748This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
749options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
750@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 751@end deftypevr
38f8b050 752
7e4aae92
JM
753@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
754
128dc8e2
JM
755@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
756
3bd36029
RS
757@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
758Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
759during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
760the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
761can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
762and @code{nomips16} attributes.
763
764Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
765registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
766operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
767in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
768significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
769for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
770switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
771
772Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
773is 0.
774@end defmac
775
38f8b050
JR
776@node Per-Function Data
777@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
778@cindex per-function data
779@cindex data structures
780
781If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
782provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
783using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
784nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
785when another one comes along.
786
787GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
788contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
789structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
790@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
791to their own specific data.
792
793If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
794@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
795This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
796@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
797
798One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
799RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
800RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
801function, for level 0.
802
803Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
804all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
805function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
806stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
807stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
808@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
809the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
810single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
811longer supported.
812
813@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
814Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
815is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
816The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
817function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
818@end defmac
819
820@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
821If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
822function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
823target to perform any target specific initialization of the
824@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
825used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
826
827@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
828Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
829GC allocation, including the structure itself.
830@end deftypevar
831
832@node Storage Layout
833@section Storage Layout
834@cindex storage layout
835
836Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
837alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
838expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
839@xref{Run-time Target}.
840
841@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
842Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
843byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
844This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
845bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
846be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
847macro need not be a constant.
848
849This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
850bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
851@end defmac
852
853@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
854Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
855word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
856@end defmac
857
858@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
859Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
860most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
861memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
862order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
863macro need not be a constant.
864@end defmac
865
38f8b050
JR
866@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
867Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
868@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
869containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
870have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
871
872You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
873multi-word integers.
874@end defmac
875
876@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
877Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
878unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
879@end defmac
880
881@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
882Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
883is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
884@end defmac
885
886@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
887Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890@end defmac
891
892@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
893Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
894register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
895@end defmac
896
897@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
898Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
899@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
900smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
901@end defmac
902
38f8b050
JR
903@defmac POINTER_SIZE
904Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
905width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
906you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
907a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
908@end defmac
909
910@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
911A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
912@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
913greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
914should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
915is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
916@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
917
918You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
919and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
920@end defmac
921
922@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
923A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
924is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
925stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
926scalar type.
927
928On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
929register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
930@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
931cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
932floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
933counterparts.
934
935For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
936However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
937either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
938the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
939sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
940@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
941
942Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
943@end defmac
944
945@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
946Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
947function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
948and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
949change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
950pointer} types.
951
952@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
953return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
954@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
955If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
956which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
957then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
958the signedness may be different.
959
5e617be8
AK
960@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
961
38f8b050
JR
962The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
963also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
964if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
965@end deftypefn
966
967@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
968Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
969bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
970regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
971size of an integer.
972@end defmac
973
974@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
975Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
976stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
977desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
978if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
979this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
980@end defmac
981
982@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
983Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
984stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
985is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
986macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
987@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
988@end defmac
989
990@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
991Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
992from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
993to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994@end defmac
995
996@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
997Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1001Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1002bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1003just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1004@end defmac
1005
1006@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1007Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1008provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1009@end defmac
1010
1011@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1012Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1013not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1014@end defmac
1015
1016@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1017If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1018object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1019nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1020on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1021@end defmac
1022
1023@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1024Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1025machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1026structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1027by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1028@end defmac
1029
1030@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1031An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1032alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1033@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1034alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1035field alignment has not been set by the
1036@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1037@end defmac
1038
1039@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1040Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1041to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1042
1043If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1044
1045@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1046@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1047@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1048@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1049@end defmac
1050
1051@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1052Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1053Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1054@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1055the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1056
1057On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1058the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1059a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1060On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1061@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1062@end defmac
1063
1064@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1065If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1066the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1067the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1068macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1069
1070If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1071
1072@findex strcpy
1073One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1074make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1075arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1076constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1077@end defmac
1078
1079@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1080If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1081that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1082@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1083have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1084align the object.
1085
1086If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1087
1088The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1089constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1090constants can be done inline.
1091@end defmac
1092
1093@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1094If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1095the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1096the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1097macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1098
1099If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1100
1101One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1102make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1103
64ad7c99 1104If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1105@end defmac
1106
1107@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1108If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1109@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1110and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1111have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1112align the slot.
1113
1114If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1115@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1116be used.
1117
1118This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1119of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1120
64ad7c99 1121If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1122@end defmac
1123
1124@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1125If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1126variable @var{decl}.
1127
1128If this macro is not defined, then
1129@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1130is used.
1131
1132One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1133make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1134
64ad7c99 1135If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1136@end defmac
1137
1138@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1139If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1140for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1141@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1142
1143If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1144@end defmac
1145
1146@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1147Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1148empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1149
1150If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1151@end defmac
1152
1153@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1154Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1155Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1156
1157If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1158@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1159@end defmac
1160
1161@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1162Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1163if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1164go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1165@end defmac
1166
1167@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1168Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1169alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1170
1171The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1172@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1173structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1174that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1175that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1176
1177Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1178@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1179four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1180not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1181
1182An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1183structure.
1184
1185If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1186a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1187
1188Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1189bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1190support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1191@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1192
1193The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1194@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1195Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1196
1197Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1198@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1199@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1200
1201If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1202bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1203what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1204
1205@smallexample
1206struct foo1
1207@{
1208 char x;
1209 char :0;
1210 char y;
1211@};
1212
1213struct foo2
1214@{
1215 char x;
1216 int :0;
1217 char y;
1218@};
1219
1220main ()
1221@{
1222 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1223 sizeof (struct foo1));
1224 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1225 sizeof (struct foo2));
1226 exit (0);
1227@}
1228@end smallexample
1229
1230If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1231get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1232@end defmac
1233
1234@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1235Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1236to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1237@end defmac
1238
1239@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1240When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1241whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1242structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1243the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1244@end deftypefn
1245
1246@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1247This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1248should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1249these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1250
1251The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1252@end deftypefn
1253
1254@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1255Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1256@code{BLKMODE}.
1257
1258If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1259mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1260case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1261retain the field's mode.
1262
1263Normally, this is not needed.
1264@end defmac
1265
1266@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1267Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1268by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1269way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1270@var{specified}.
1271
1272The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1273the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1274@end defmac
1275
1276@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1277An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1278machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1279this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1280appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1281(DImode)} is assumed.
1282@end defmac
1283
1284@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1285If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1286specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1287@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1288@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1289@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1290having its mode specified.
1291
1292You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1293would most commonly define this macro if the
1294@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
129564-bit mode.
1296@end defmac
1297
1298@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1299If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1300specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1301@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1302
1303You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1304You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1305pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1306@end defmac
1307
1308@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1309This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1310of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1311@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1312targets.
1313@end deftypefn
1314
1315@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1316This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1317of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1318@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1319targets.
1320@end deftypefn
1321
1322@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1323Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1324The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1325@end deftypefn
1326
1327@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1328If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1329mode is towards zero.
1330
1331Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1332floating-point arithmetic.
1333
1334Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1335@end defmac
1336
1337@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1338This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1339bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1340exponent for normal numbers instead.
1341
1342Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1343floating-point arithmetic.
1344
1345The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1346@end defmac
1347
1348@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1349This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1350@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1351Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1352unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1353different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1354alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1355bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1356the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1357(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1358another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1359other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1360
1361When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1362of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1363bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1364and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1365chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1366size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1367alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1368
1369If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1370the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1371used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1372precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1373may affect its placement.
1374@end deftypefn
1375
1376@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1377Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1378@end deftypefn
1379
1380@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1381Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1382@end deftypefn
1383
1384@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1385This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1386to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1387For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1388for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1389registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1390usage.
1391@end deftypefn
1392
1393@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1394This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1395that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1396@end deftypefn
1397
1398@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1399If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1400uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1401to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1402mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1403the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1404not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1405for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1406return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1407string constant.
1408
1409Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1410qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1411fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1412is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1413length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1414ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1415@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1416@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1417code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1418@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1419codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1420spaces in your string.
1421
1422This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1423name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1424can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1425before mangling.
1426
1427The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1428appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1429types.
1430@end deftypefn
1431
1432@node Type Layout
1433@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1434
1435These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1436basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1437the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1438languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1439
1440@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1441A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1442target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1443@end defmac
1444
1445@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1446A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1447target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1448(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1449unit.)
1450@end defmac
1451
1452@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1453A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1454target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1455@end defmac
1456
1457@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1458On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1459@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1460that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1461the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1462value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1463@end defmac
1464
1465@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1466A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1467target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1468words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1469macro must be at least 64.
1470@end defmac
1471
1472@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1473A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1474target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1475@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1476@end defmac
1477
1478@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1479A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1480C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1481this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1482@end defmac
1483
1484@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1485A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1486target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1487@end defmac
1488
1489@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1490A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1491target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1492words.
1493@end defmac
1494
1495@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1496A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1497the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1498words.
1499@end defmac
1500
1501@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1502A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1503the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1504@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1505@end defmac
1506
1507@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1508A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1509the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1510@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1511@end defmac
1512
1513@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1514A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1515the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1516@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1517@end defmac
1518
1519@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1520A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1521the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1522@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1523@end defmac
1524
1525@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1526A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1527the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1528@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1529@end defmac
1530
1531@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1532A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1533the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1534@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1535@end defmac
1536
1537@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1538A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1539the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1540@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1541@end defmac
1542
1543@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1544A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1545the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1546@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1547@end defmac
1548
1549@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1550Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1551if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1552@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1553default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1554@end defmac
1555
1556@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1557Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1558@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1559@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1560anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1561or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1562otherwise it is 0.
1563@end defmac
1564
1565@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1566Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1567@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1568anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1569is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1570@end defmac
1571
1572@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1573Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1574@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1575anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1576is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1577@end defmac
1578
cdbf4541
BS
1579@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1580This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1581hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1582causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1583prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1584uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1585the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1586@end defmac
1587
38f8b050
JR
1588@defmac SF_SIZE
1589@defmacx DF_SIZE
1590@defmacx XF_SIZE
1591@defmacx TF_SIZE
1592Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1593@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1594if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1595@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1596for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1597@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1598@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1599@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1600@end defmac
1601
1602@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1603A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1604assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1605default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1606@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1607@end defmac
1608
1609@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1610A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1611supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1612value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1613If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1614is the default.
1615@end defmac
1616
1617@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1618An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1619@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1620always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1621and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1622@end defmac
1623
1624@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1625This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1626@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1627of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1628@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1629
1630The default is to return false.
1631@end deftypefn
1632
1633@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1634A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1636contents of the string.
1637
1638The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1639spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1640appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1641of the data type names defined in the function
1642@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1643omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1644crash on startup.
1645
1646If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1647int"}.
1648@end defmac
1649
1650@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1651A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1652for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1653@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1654@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1655
1656If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1657@end defmac
1658
1659@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1660A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1661for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1662the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1663information.
1664
1665If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1666@end defmac
1667
1668@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1669A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1670characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1671@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1672@end defmac
1673
1674@defmac WINT_TYPE
1675A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1676use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1677@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1678contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1679information.
1680
1681If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1682@end defmac
1683
1684@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1685A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1687The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1688string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1689
1690If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1692much precision as @code{long long int}.
1693@end defmac
1694
1695@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1696A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1697can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1698type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1699of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1700
1701If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1702@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1703unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1704int}.
1705@end defmac
1706
1707@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1709@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1710@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1711@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1714@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1715@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1717@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1718@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1719@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1721@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1723@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1724@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1725@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1726@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1727@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1728@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1729@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1730@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1731@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1732@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1733@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1734C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1735@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1736@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1737@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1738@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1739@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1740@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1741@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1742@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1743@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1744
1745If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1746type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1747@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1748to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1749these macros are null pointers.
1750@end defmac
1751
1752@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1753The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1754that looks like:
1755
1756@smallexample
1757 struct @{
1758 union @{
1759 void (*fn)();
1760 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1761 @};
1762 ptrdiff_t delta;
1763 @};
1764@end smallexample
1765
1766@noindent
1767The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1768will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1769Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1770always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1771distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1772platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1773that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1774the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1775
1776GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1777this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1778However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1779set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1780bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1781address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1782architecture, you should define this macro to
1783@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1784
1785In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1786in which function addresses are always even, according to
1787@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1788@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1789@end defmac
1790
1791@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1792Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1793macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1794instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1795function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1796data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1797pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1798
1799If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1800of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1801@end defmac
1802
1803@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1804By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1805is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1806the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1807when special alignment is necessary. */
1808@end defmac
1809
1810@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1811There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1812zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1813specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1814of words in each data entry.
1815@end defmac
1816
1817@node Registers
1818@section Register Usage
1819@cindex register usage
1820
1821This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1822has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1823
1824The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1825done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1826on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1827For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1828For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1829
1830@menu
1831* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1832* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1833* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1834* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1835* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1836@end menu
1837
1838@node Register Basics
1839@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1840
1841@c prevent bad page break with this line
1842Registers have various characteristics.
1843
1844@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1845Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1846numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1847pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1848@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1849@end defmac
1850
1851@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1852@cindex fixed register
1853An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1854all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1855general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1856pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1857register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1858machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1859and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1860
1861This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1862commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1863register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1864
1865The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1866the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1867by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1868the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1869@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1870@end defmac
1871
1872@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1873@cindex call-used register
1874@cindex call-clobbered register
1875@cindex call-saved register
1876Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1877clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1878registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1879available for general allocation of values that must live across
1880function calls.
1881
1882If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1883automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1884exit, if the register is used within the function.
1885@end defmac
1886
1887@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1888@cindex call-used register
1889@cindex call-clobbered register
1890@cindex call-saved register
1891Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1892that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1893(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1894This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1895of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1896@end defmac
1897
1898@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1899@cindex call-used register
1900@cindex call-clobbered register
1901@cindex call-saved register
1902A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1903value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1904call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1905macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1906preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1907@end defmac
1908
1909@findex fixed_regs
1910@findex call_used_regs
1911@findex global_regs
1912@findex reg_names
1913@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1914@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1915This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1916@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1917@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1918any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1919of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1920@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1921@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1922called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1923@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1924from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1925@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1926@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1927@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1928command options have been applied.
1929
38f8b050
JR
1930@cindex disabling certain registers
1931@cindex controlling register usage
1932If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1933flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1934@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1935registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1936the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1937to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1938is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1939
1940(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1941of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1942controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1943these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1944@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1945
1946@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1947Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1948expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1949corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1950function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1951outbound register.
1952@end defmac
1953
1954@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1955Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1956expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1957corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1958function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1959register.
1960@end defmac
1961
1962@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1963Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1964expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1965register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1966need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1967gotos.
1968@end defmac
1969
1970@defmac PC_REGNUM
1971If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1972register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1973@end defmac
1974
1975@node Allocation Order
1976@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1977@cindex order of register allocation
1978@cindex register allocation order
1979
1980@c prevent bad page break with this line
1981Registers are allocated in order.
1982
1983@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1984If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1985numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1986to use them (from most preferred to least).
1987
1988If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1989(all else being equal).
1990
1991One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1992registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1993instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1994machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1995the highest numbered allocable register first.
1996@end defmac
1997
1998@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1999A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2000hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2001
2002Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2003Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2004register; and so on.
2005
2006The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2007@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2008
2009On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2010@end defmac
2011
2012@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2013Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2014prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2015using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2016allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2017call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2018should be defined.
2019@end defmac
2020
2021@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2022In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2023Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2024If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2025based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2026be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2027value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2028to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2029
2030On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2031@end defmac
2032
2033@node Values in Registers
2034@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2035
2036This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2037(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2038consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2039
2040@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2041A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2042at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2043@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2044cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2045and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2046
2047On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2048definition of this macro is
2049
2050@smallexample
2051#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2052 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2053 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2054@end smallexample
2055@end defmac
2056
2057@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2058A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2059in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2060in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2061multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2062this mode by the number of registers returned by
2063@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2064
2065For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2066registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2067nonzero.
2068
2069This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2070@code{subreg_get_info}
2071would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2072represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2073@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2074registers and so not be representable.
2075@end defmac
2076
2077@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2078For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2079@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2080returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2081including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2082@end defmac
2083
2084@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2085Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2086of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2087should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2088used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2089happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2090floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2091@end defmac
2092
2093@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2094A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2095of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2096registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2097are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2098
2099@smallexample
2100#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2101@end smallexample
2102
2103You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2104because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2105
2106@cindex register pairs
2107On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2108register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2109odd register numbers for such modes.
2110
2111The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2112@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2113register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2114value into the register and back out not alter it.
2115
2116Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2117all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2118@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2119you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2120is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2121and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2122to be tieable.
2123
2124Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2125Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2126in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2127can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2128mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2129registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2130
2131On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2132modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2133registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2134non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2135@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2136floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2137normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2138unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2139register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2140
2141The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2142they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2143instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2144@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2145constraints for those instructions.
2146
2147On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2148so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2149register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2150floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2151be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2152@end defmac
2153
2154@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2155A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2156@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2157
2158One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2159another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2160handler.
2161
2162The default is always nonzero.
2163@end defmac
2164
2165@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2166A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2167@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2168
2169If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2170@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2171any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2172should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2173this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2174accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2175
2176You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2177possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2178allocation.
2179@end defmac
2180
2181@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2182This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2183@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2184
2185One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2186is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2187
2188The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2189@end deftypefn
2190
2191@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2192Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2193registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2194@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2195@end defmac
2196
2197@node Leaf Functions
2198@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2199
2200@cindex leaf functions
2201@cindex functions, leaf
2202On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2203more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2204means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2205are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2206normally arrive.
2207
2208The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2209other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2210registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2211function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2212handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2213functions''.
2214
2215GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2216suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2217registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2218accomplish this.
2219
2220@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2221Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2222contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2223function treatment.
2224
2225If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2226registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2227GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2228used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2229in this vector.
2230
2231Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2232the treatment of leaf functions.
2233@end defmac
2234
2235@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2236A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2237should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2238
2239If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2240function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2241will cause the compiler to abort.
2242
2243Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2244treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2245this.
2246@end defmac
2247
2248@findex current_function_is_leaf
2249@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2250@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2251@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2252specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2253which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2254set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2255compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2256@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2257functions which only use leaf registers.
2258@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2259that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2260@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2261@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2262@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2263
2264@node Stack Registers
2265@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2266
2267There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2268``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2269pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2270stack.
2271
2272Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2273they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2274support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2275point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2276stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2277@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2278with it, as well as defining these macros.
2279
2280@defmac STACK_REGS
2281Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2282@end defmac
2283
2284@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2285This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2286the machine has any stack-like registers.
2287@end defmac
2288
2289@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2290The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2291of the stack.
2292@end defmac
2293
2294@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2295The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2296the stack.
2297@end defmac
2298
2299@node Register Classes
2300@section Register Classes
2301@cindex register class definitions
2302@cindex class definitions, register
2303
2304On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2305For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2306certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2307restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2308
2309You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2310which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2311that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2312
2313@findex ALL_REGS
2314@findex NO_REGS
2315In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2316class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2317class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2318union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2319
2320@findex GENERAL_REGS
2321One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2322terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2323@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2324the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2325to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2326
2327Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2328then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2329
2330The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2331constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2332You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2333them in operand constraints.
2334
6049a4c8
HPN
2335You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2336registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2337some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2338cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2339(@pxref{Costs}).
2340
38f8b050
JR
2341You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2342instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2343either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2344certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2345which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2346or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2347class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2348
2349You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2350classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2351contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2352in their union.
2353
2354When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2355certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2356Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2357a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2358specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2359
2360Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2361instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2362each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2363mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2364single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2365this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2366instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2367single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2368@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2369
2370@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2371An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2372as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2373must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2374@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2375tells how many classes there are.
2376
2377Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2378the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2379in many of the tables described below.
2380@end deftp
2381
2382@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2383The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2384
2385@smallexample
2386#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2387@end smallexample
2388@end defmac
2389
2390@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2391An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2392constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2393@end defmac
2394
2395@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2396An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2397which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2398@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2399register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2400
2401When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2402Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2403several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2404for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2405In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2406registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2407so on.
2408@end defmac
2409
2410@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2411A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2412@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2413which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2414register.
2415@end defmac
2416
2417@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2418A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2419base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2420which is the register value plus a displacement.
2421@end defmac
2422
2423@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2424This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2425the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2426@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2427@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2428@end defmac
2429
2430@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2431A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2432base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2433register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2434addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2435@end defmac
2436
2437@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2438A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2439base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2440context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2441the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2442address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2443@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2444index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2445@end defmac
2446
2447@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2448A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2449index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2450address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2451added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2452@end defmac
2453
2454@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2455A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2456suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2457@end defmac
2458
2459@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2461that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2462@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2463reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2464you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2465@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2466addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2467@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2468@end defmac
2469
2470@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2471A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2472use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2473memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2474pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2475define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2476than other base register uses.
2477
2478Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2479@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2480@end defmac
2481
2482@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2483A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2484that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2485appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2486immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2487address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2488@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2489corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2490@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2491that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2492@end defmac
2493
2494@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2495A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2496suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2497either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2498allocated such a hard register.
2499
2500The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2501the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2502two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2503labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2504labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2505may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2506looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2507only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2508@end defmac
2509
5f286f4a
YQ
2510@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2511
fba42e24
AS
2512@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2513A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2514to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2515@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2516another, smaller class.
2517
2518The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2519
2520Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2521example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2522for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2523@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2524Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2525
2526One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2527@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2528loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2529force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2530immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2531instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2532register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2533@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2534into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2535@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2536of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2537
2538If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2539through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2540to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2541reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2542this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2543the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2544@end deftypefn
2545
38f8b050
JR
2546@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2547A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2548to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2549@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2550another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2551safe:
2552
2553@smallexample
2554#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2555@end smallexample
2556
2557Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2558example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2559for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2560@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2561Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2562
2563One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2564@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2565loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2566force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2567immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2568instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2569register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2570@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2571into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2572@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2573of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
38f8b050
JR
2574
2575If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2576through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2577to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2578reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2579this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2580the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2581@end defmac
2582
2583@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2584Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2585input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2586@var{class}, unchanged.
2587
2588You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2589reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2590@end defmac
2591
abd26bfb
AS
2592@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2593Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2594input reloads.
2595
2596The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2597argument.
2598
2599You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2600reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2601@end deftypefn
2602
38f8b050
JR
2603@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2604A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2605to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2606@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2607ordinarily be used.
2608
2609Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2610there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2611
2612The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2613smaller class.
2614
2615Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2616require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2617@end defmac
2618
2619@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2620Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2621from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2622@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2623from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2624term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2625directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2626register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2627destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2628source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2629reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2630and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2631intermediate register still holds the required value.
2632
2633Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2634allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2635register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2636address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2637when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2638as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2639that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2640describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2641these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2642of the scratch register(s).
2643
2644In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2645
2646For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2647and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2648@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2649hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2650needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2651
2652If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2653an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2654return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2655If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2656If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2657that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2658
2659If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2660perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2661closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2662required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2663copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2664
2665You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2666in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2667and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2668for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2669single-register-class
2670@c [later: or memory]
2671output constraint.
2672
2673When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2674hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2675register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2676have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2677
2678@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2679@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2680@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2681@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2682@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2683@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2684@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2685@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2686
2687
2688@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2689pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2690Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2691in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2692
2693Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2694currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2695to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2696
2697@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2698copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2699(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2700Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2701of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2702forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2703@end deftypefn
2704
2705@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2706@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2707@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2708These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2709@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2710
2711These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2712target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2713reload phase that it may
2714need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2715register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2716register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2717you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2718largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2719intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2720
2721If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2722intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2723was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2724class required. If the
2725requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2726@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2727macros identically.
2728
2729The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2730Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2731can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2732@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2733macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2734
2735If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2736intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2737@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2738(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2739implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2740@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2741register.
2742
2743These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2744register that
2745contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2746class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2747value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2748register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2749Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2750
2751@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2752pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2753Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2754in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2755
2756These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2757registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2758registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2759would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2760the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2761intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2762general registers.
2763@end defmac
2764
2765@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2766Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2767to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2768those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2769@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2770class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2771and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2772
2773Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2774@end defmac
2775
2776@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2777Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2778allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2779If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2780defined by this macro.
2781
2782Do not define this macro if you do not define
2783@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2784@end defmac
2785
2786@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2787When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2788registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2789hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2790load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2791same as that of @var{mode}.
2792
2793This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2794bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2795in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2796registers.
2797
2798However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2799the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2800differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2801widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2802suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2803details.
2804
2805Do not define this macro if you do not define
2806@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2807is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2808@end defmac
2809
07b8f0a8
AS
2810@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2811A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2812to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2813registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2814
2815The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2816has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2817default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2818if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2819hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2820@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2821@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2822register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2823you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2824the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2825allocation.
2826@end deftypefn
2827
38f8b050
JR
2828@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2829A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2830of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2831
2832This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2833the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2834should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2835@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2836
2837This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2838in the reload pass.
2839@end defmac
2840
2841@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2842If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2843a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2844
2845For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2846floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2847Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2848does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2849register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2850as below:
2851
2852@smallexample
2853#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2854 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2855 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2856@end smallexample
2857@end defmac
2858
38f8b050
JR
2859@node Old Constraints
2860@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2861@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2862@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2863
2864Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2865of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2866Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2867it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2868
2869@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2870For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2871@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2872constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2873you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2874constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2875DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2876to handle specially.
2877There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2878for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2879transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2880return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2881will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2882@end defmac
2883
2884@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2885A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2886letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2887value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2888the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2889corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2890to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2891@end defmac
2892
2893@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2894Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2895passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2896different variants.
2897@end defmac
2898
2899@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2900A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2901letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2902particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2903letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2904the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2905not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2906@var{value}.
2907@end defmac
2908
2909@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2910Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2911string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2912between different variants.
2913@end defmac
2914
2915@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2916A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2917letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2918(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2919
2920If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2921@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2922range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2923letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2924
2925@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2926@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2927or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2928between these kinds.
2929@end defmac
2930
2931@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2932Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2933string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2934between different variants.
2935@end defmac
2936
2937@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2938A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2939letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2940memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2941elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2942@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2943may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2944
2945If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2946if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2947constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2948constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2949
2950For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2951in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2952letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2953@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2954a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2955alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2956does not include r0 on the output.
2957@end defmac
2958
2959@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2960Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2961in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2962variants.
2963@end defmac
2964
2965@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2966A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2967letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2968be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2969
2970It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2971at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2972comprises a subset of all memory references including
2973all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2974pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2975type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2976
2977For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2978memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2979register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2980@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2981If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2982a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2983reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2984into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2985an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2986@end defmac
2987
2988@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2989A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2990letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2991@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2992be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2993
2994It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2995at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2996a subset of all memory addresses including
2997all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2998pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2999type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3000
3001Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3002be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3003analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3004@end defmac
3005
3006@node Stack and Calling
3007@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3008@cindex calling conventions
3009
3010@c prevent bad page break with this line
3011This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3012
3013@menu
3014* Frame Layout::
3015* Exception Handling::
3016* Stack Checking::
3017* Frame Registers::
3018* Elimination::
3019* Stack Arguments::
3020* Register Arguments::
3021* Scalar Return::
3022* Aggregate Return::
3023* Caller Saves::
3024* Function Entry::
3025* Profiling::
3026* Tail Calls::
3027* Stack Smashing Protection::
3028@end menu
3029
3030@node Frame Layout
3031@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3032@cindex stack frame layout
3033@cindex frame layout
3034
3035@c prevent bad page break with this line
3036Here is the basic stack layout.
3037
3038@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3039Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3040pointer to a smaller address.
3041
3042When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3043compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3044definition used does not matter.
3045@end defmac
3046
3047@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3048This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3049on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3050@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3051
3052The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3053and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3054the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3055to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3056space for the next item on the stack.
3057
3058The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3059defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3060which is often wrong.
3061@end defmac
3062
3063@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3064Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3065are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3066@end defmac
3067
3068@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3069Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3070addresses on the stack.
3071@end defmac
3072
3073@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3074Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3075
3076If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3077subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3078Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3079value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3080@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3081@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3082@end defmac
3083
3084@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3085Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3086The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3087
3088On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3089is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3090alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3091stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3092@end defmac
3093
3094@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3095Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3096outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3097zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3098
3099If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3100the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3101@end defmac
3102
3103@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3104Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3105address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3106function.
3107
3108If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3109the first argument's address.
3110@end defmac
3111
3112@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3113Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3114on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3115
3116The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3117length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3118machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3119@end defmac
3120
3121@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3122A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3123stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3124@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3125default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3126elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3127@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3128@end defmac
3129
3130@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3131A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3132frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3133@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3134itself.
3135
3136If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3137of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3138address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3139@end defmac
3140
3141@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3142If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3143setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3144on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3145before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3146define this macro.
3147@end defmac
3148
3149@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3150This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3151the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3152The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3153machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3154@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3155@end deftypefn
3156
3157@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3158A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3159address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3160of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3161You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3162as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3163@end defmac
3164
3165@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3166A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3167address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3168the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3169frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3170@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3171
3172The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3173@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3174determine the return address of other frames.
3175@end defmac
3176
3177@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3178Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3179from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3180@end defmac
3181
3182@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3183A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3184incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3185prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3186value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3187the stack.
3188
3189You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3190debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3191
3192If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3193@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3194@end defmac
3195
3196@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3197A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3198number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3199must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3200be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3201
3202This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3203general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3204frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3205over time.
3206@end defmac
3207
3208@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3209A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3210number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3211only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3212someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3213terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3214@end defmac
3215
3216@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3217This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3218contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3219info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3220@smallexample
3221(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3222@end smallexample
3223and
3224@smallexample
3225(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3226@end smallexample
3227to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3228the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3229the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3230@end deftypefn
3231
3232@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3233A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3234from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3235frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3236the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3237previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3238
3239You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3240debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3241@end defmac
3242
3243@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3244A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3245from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3246final value should coincide with that calculated by
3247@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3248during virtual register instantiation.
3249
3250The default value for this macro is
3251@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3252which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3253immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3254some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3255and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3256
3257You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3258want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3259DWARF 2.
3260@end defmac
3261
3262@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3263If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3264in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3265The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3266@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3267
3268Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3269via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3270variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3271defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3272based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3273of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3274should be defined.
3275@end defmac
3276
3277@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3278If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3279in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3280in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3281may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3282@end defmac
3283
3284@node Exception Handling
3285@subsection Exception Handling Support
3286@cindex exception handling
3287
3288@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3289A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3290data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3291@var{N} registers are usable.
3292
3293The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3294handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3295should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3296but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
32972 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3298
3299You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3300handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3301@end defmac
3302
3303@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3304A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3305to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3306This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3307It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3308
3309Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3310untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3311
3312Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3313by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3314this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3315stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3316this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3317that provided by DWARF 2.
3318@end defmac
3319
3320@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3321A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3322to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3323return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3324
3325Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3326return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3327address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3328the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3329frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3330been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3331target call frame.
3332
3333Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3334address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3335the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3336
3337If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3338define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3339@end defmac
3340
3341@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3342If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3343to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3344exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3345using it to return to the exception handler.
3346@end defmac
3347
3348@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3349This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3350handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3351that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3352and so may be read-only.
3353
3354@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3355@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3356The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3357as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3358
3359If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3360represented directly.
3361@end defmac
3362
3363@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3364This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3365to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3366Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3367be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3368
3369This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3370handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3371of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3372to be emitted.
3373@end defmac
3374
38f8b050
JR
3375@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3376This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3377code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3378available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3379through signal frames.
3380
3381This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3382@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3383@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3384@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3385for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3386the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3387save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3388evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3389the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3390
3391For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3392@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3393@end defmac
3394
3395@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3396This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3397call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3398usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3399
3400This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3401@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3402@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3403for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3404@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3405be updated in @var{fs}.
3406@end defmac
3407
3408@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3409A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3410info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3411linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3412@end defmac
3413
3414@node Stack Checking
3415@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3416
3417GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3418stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3419three ways:
3420
3421@enumerate
3422@item
3423If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3424will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3425at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3426other special processing.
3427
3428@item
3429If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3430@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3431that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3432static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3433in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3434stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3435approach below.
3436
3437@item
3438If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3439``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3440@end enumerate
3441
3442If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3443GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3444@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3445dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3446
3447@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3448A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3449machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3450is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3451checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3452value of this macro is zero.
3453@end defmac
3454
3455@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3456A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3457in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3458like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3459approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3460@end defmac
3461
3462@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3463An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3464instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3465define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3466the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3467of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3468@end defmac
3469
3470@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3471An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3472when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3473contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3474thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3475is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3476default value of this macro is zero.
3477@end defmac
3478
3479@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3480The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3481languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3482with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34838192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3484most machines.
3485@end defmac
3486
3487The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3488nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3489in the opposite case.
3490
3491@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3492The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3493instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3494stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3495checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3496default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3497systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3498@end defmac
3499
3500@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3501GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3502represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3503space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3504You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3505use the default of four words.
3506@end defmac
3507
3508@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3509The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3510fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3511@option{-fstack-check}.
3512GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3513normally not need to override that default.
3514@end defmac
3515
3516@need 2000
3517@node Frame Registers
3518@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3519
3520@c prevent bad page break with this line
3521This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3522
3523@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3524The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3525fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3526the hardware determines which register this is.
3527@end defmac
3528
3529@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3530The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3531access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3532hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3533choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3534@end defmac
3535
3536@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3537On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3538offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3539allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3540between these two locations). On those machines, define
3541@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3542be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3543@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3544used for the frame pointer.
3545
3546You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3547is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3548the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3549completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3550definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3551@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3552or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3553
3554Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3555@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3556@end defmac
3557
3558@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3559The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3560the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3561frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3562register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3563wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3564pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3565@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3566(@pxref{Elimination}).
3567@end defmac
3568
e3339d0f
JM
3569@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3570Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3571@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3572the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3573== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3574definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3575@end defmac
3576
3577@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3578Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3579@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3580same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3581ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3582definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3583@end defmac
3584
38f8b050
JR
3585@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3586The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3587access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3588machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3589pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3590to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3591@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3592
3593Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3594address from the stack.
3595@end defmac
3596
3597@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3598@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3599Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3600register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3601function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3602number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3603these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3604not be defined.
3605
3606The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3607
3608If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3609defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3610@end defmac
3611
3612@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3613This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3614targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3615nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3616attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3617those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3618
3619The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3620
3621If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3622provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3623Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3624from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3625will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3626@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3627@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3628@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3629The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3630@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3631to refer to those items.
3632@end deftypefn
3633
3634@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3635This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3636saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3637DWARF2 exception handling.
3638
3639Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3640exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3641extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3642in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3643used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3644routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3645registers that are not call-saved.
3646
3647If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3648@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3649@end defmac
3650
3651@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3652
3653This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3654for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3655
3656If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3657@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3658@end defmac
3659
3660@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3661
3662Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3663is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3664Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3665column number to use instead.
3666
3667See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3668@end defmac
3669
3670@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3671
3672Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3673used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3674debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3675should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3676@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3677
3678@end defmac
3679
3680@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3681
3682Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3683that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3684should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3685.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3686return @code{@var{regno}}.
3687
3688@end defmac
3689
3690@node Elimination
3691@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3692
3693@c prevent bad page break with this line
3694This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3695
3696@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3697This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3698a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3699value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3700
3701This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3702according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3703constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3704to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3705Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3706pointer.
3707
3708In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3709without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3710automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3711@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3712them.
3713
3714In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3715register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3716fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3717
3718Default return value is @code{false}.
3719@end deftypefn
3720
3721@findex get_frame_size
3722@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3723A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3724between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3725the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3726such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3727registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3728
3729If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3730need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3731@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3732case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3733@end defmac
3734
3735@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3736If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3737eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3738defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3739references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3740
3741The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3742of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3743
3744On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3745the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3746must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3747replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3748depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3749
3750In this case, you might specify:
3751@smallexample
3752#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3753@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3754 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3755 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3756@end smallexample
3757
3758Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3759specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3760@end defmac
3761
3762@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3763This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3764try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3765@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3766is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3767preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3768knows about.
3769
3770Default return value is @code{true}.
3771@end deftypefn
3772
3773@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3774This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3775specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3776registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3777defined.
3778@end defmac
3779
3780@node Stack Arguments
3781@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3782@cindex arguments on stack
3783@cindex stack arguments
3784
3785The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3786on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3787control passing certain arguments in registers.
3788
3789@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3790This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3791prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3792passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3793cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3794The default is to not promote prototypes.
3795@end deftypefn
3796
3797@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3798A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3799outgoing arguments.
3800If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3801That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3802allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3803it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3804@end defmac
3805
3806@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3807A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3808last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3809defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3810and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3811@end defmac
3812
3813@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3814A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3815stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3816
3817On some machines, the definition
3818
3819@smallexample
3820#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3821@end smallexample
3822
3823@noindent
3824will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3825to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3826alignment. Then the definition should be
3827
3828@smallexample
3829#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3830@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3831
64ad7c99 3832If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3833@end defmac
3834
3835@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3836@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3837A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3838will be computed and placed into the variable
3839@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3840onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3841increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3842
3843Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3844is not proper.
3845@end defmac
3846
3847@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3848Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3849allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3850registers.
3851
3852The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3853arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3854which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3855The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3856of the function.
3857
3858This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3859machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3860which.
3861@end defmac
3862@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3863@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3864
3865@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3866Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3867caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3868when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3869if the function called is a library function.
3870
3871If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3872whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3873@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3874@end defmac
3875
3876@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3877Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3878stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3879@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3880@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3881
3882Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3883stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3884suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3885stack in its natural location.
3886@end defmac
3887
893d13d5 3888@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3889This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3890a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3891and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3892
3893@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3894the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3895@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3896From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3897
3898@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3899describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3900@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3901From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3902arguments (if known).
3903
3904When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3905will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3906you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3907by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3908a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3909in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3910
893d13d5 3911@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3912stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3913argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3914
3915On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3916of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3917calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3918the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3919convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3920arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3921nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3922@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3923number of arguments.
3924@end deftypefn
3925
3926@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3927A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3928pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3929when compiling a function call.
3930
3931@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3932have been accumulated.
3933
3934On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3935that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3936that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3937call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3938appropriate.
3939@end defmac
3940
3941@node Register Arguments
3942@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3943@cindex arguments in registers
3944@cindex registers arguments
3945
3946This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3947types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3948the stack.
3949
b25b9e8f
NF
3950@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3951Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3952register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3953
b25b9e8f 3954The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3955arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3956the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3957(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3958which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3959nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3960function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3961syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3962
b25b9e8f
NF
3963The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3964register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3965on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3966
3967The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3968used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3969@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3970@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3971describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3972@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3973register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3974register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3975second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3976the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3977As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3978RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3979argument is also stored on the stack.
3980
b25b9e8f 3981The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
3982VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3983pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3984
3985@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
3986The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3987machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3988cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3989done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3990@var{named} is @code{false}.
3991
3992@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3993@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
3994You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3995in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3996type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 3997is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
3998argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3999defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4000a register.
b25b9e8f 4001@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4002
4003@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4004This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4005solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4006definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4007documentation.
4008@end deftypefn
4009
b25b9e8f
NF
4010@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4011Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
4012that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4013necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4014argument.
4015
b25b9e8f
NF
4016For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4017which the caller passes the value, and
4018@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4019fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4020arrive.
38f8b050 4021
b25b9e8f
NF
4022If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4023@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4024@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4025
4026@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4027This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4028argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4029arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4030pushed on the stack.
4031
4032On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4033registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4034first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4035on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4036structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4037in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4038compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4039
b25b9e8f 4040@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4041register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4042@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4043@end deftypefn
4044
ec9f85e5 4045@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4046This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4047position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4048predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4049passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4050
4051If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4052pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4053The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4054to that type.
4055@end deftypefn
4056
4057@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4058The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4059known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4060function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4061by the caller.
4062
4063For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4064determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4065not be generated.
4066
4067The default version of this hook always returns false.
4068@end deftypefn
4069
4070@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4071A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4072of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4073target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4074of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4075
4076There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4077arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4078variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4079arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4080@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4081should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4082@end defmac
4083
4084@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4085If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4086function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4087created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4088reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4089If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4090@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4091@end defmac
4092
4093@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4094A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4095@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4096variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4097is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4098the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4099For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4100declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4101@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4102being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4103arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4104parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4105@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4106
4107When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4108@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4109contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4110an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4111macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4112never both of them at once.
4113@end defmac
4114
4115@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4116Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4117it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4118@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4119is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41200)} is used instead.
4121@end defmac
4122
4123@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4124Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4125finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4126undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4127
4128The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4129with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4130argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4131@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4132@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4133@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4134@end defmac
4135
b25b9e8f
NF
4136@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4137This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4138advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4139@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4140the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4141argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4142
b25b9e8f 4143This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4144on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4145used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4146@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4147
4148@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4149If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4150offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4151which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4152slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4153top.
4154@end defmac
4155
4156@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4157If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4158to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4159@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4160@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4161
4162The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
c2ed6cf8
NF
4163multiple of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not
4164control it.
38f8b050
JR
4165
4166This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4167For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4168big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4169constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4170@end defmac
4171
4172@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4173If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4174implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4175next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4176controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4177arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4178@end defmac
4179
4180@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4181Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4182memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4183macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4184machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4185@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4186registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4187a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4188required.
4189@end defmac
4190
c2ed6cf8 4191@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4192This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4193with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4194@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4195@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4196
4197@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4198A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4199register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4200@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4201the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4202used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4203stack.
4204@end defmac
4205
4206@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4207This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4208as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4209arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4210to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4211AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4212registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4213point register.
4214
4215The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4216false.
4217@end deftypefn
4218
4219@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4220This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4221The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4222@end deftypefn
4223
07a5b2bc 4224@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4225This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4226to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4227variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4228to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4229variable.
07a5b2bc 4230The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4231this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4232internal type.
4233If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4234Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4235macro to iterate through all types.
4236@end deftypefn
4237
4238@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4239This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4240@var{fndecl}.
4241The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4242@end deftypefn
4243
4244@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4245This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4246type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4247@code{NULL_TREE}.
4248@end deftypefn
4249
4250@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4251This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4252@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4253arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4254@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4255@end deftypefn
4256
4257@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4258Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4259with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4260hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4261@end deftypefn
4262
7352c013
RG
4263@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4264
38f8b050
JR
4265@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4266Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4267insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4268considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4269must work.
4270
4271The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4272required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4273Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4274code in @file{optabs.c}.
4275@end deftypefn
4276
4277@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4278Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4279insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4280must have move patterns for this mode.
4281@end deftypefn
4282
0f6d54f7
RS
4283@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4284
38f8b050
JR
4285@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4286Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4287small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4288@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4289in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4290In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4291for any mode.
4292
4293On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4294insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4295to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4296if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4297insn.
4298
4299Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4300in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4301the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4302classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4303registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4304registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4305SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4306strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4307machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4308
2b0d3573 4309The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4310safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4311unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4312that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4313to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4314of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4315@end deftypefn
4316
e692f276
RH
4317@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4318
38f8b050
JR
4319@node Scalar Return
4320@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4321@cindex return values in registers
4322@cindex values, returned by functions
4323@cindex scalars, returned as values
4324
4325This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4326values---values that can fit in registers.
4327
4328@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4329
4330Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4331returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4332representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4333representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4334function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4335compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4336Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4337a function returns a value.
4338
4339On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4340(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4341place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4342@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4343The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4344multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4345@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4346location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4347the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4348that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4349port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4350@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4351
4352If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4353the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4354@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4355
4356If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4357node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4358pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4359convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4360known.
4361
4362Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4363which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4364the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4365different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4366
4367@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4368aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4369@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4370@end deftypefn
4371
4372@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4373This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4374a new target instead.
4375@end defmac
4376
4377@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4378A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4379function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4380
4381Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4382support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4383specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4384compiled.
4385@end defmac
4386
4387@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4388Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4389function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
38f8b050
JR
4390
4391The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4392library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
38f8b050
JR
4393representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4394
4395If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4396@end deftypefn
4397
4398@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4399A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4400register in which the values of called function may come back.
4401
4402A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4403second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4404recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4405suffices:
4406
4407@smallexample
4408#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4409@end smallexample
4410
4411If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4412function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4413should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4414
4415This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4416for a new target instead.
4417@end defmac
4418
4419@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4420A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4421register in which the values of called function may come back.
4422
4423A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4424second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4425recognized by this target hook.
4426
4427If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4428function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4429should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4430
4431If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4432@end deftypefn
4433
4434@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4435Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4436need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4437saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4438@end defmac
4439
4440@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4441This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4442at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4443padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4444is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4445
4446Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4447be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4448or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44494-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4450@code{SImode} rtx.
4451@end deftypefn
4452
4453@node Aggregate Return
4454@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4455@cindex aggregates as return values
4456@cindex large return values
4457@cindex returning aggregate values
4458@cindex structure value address
4459
4460When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4461cases), the value is not returned according to
4462@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4463caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4464should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4465address}.
4466
4467This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4468memory.
4469
4470@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4471This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4472function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4473Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4474will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4475libcalls.
4476
4477Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4478by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4479takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4480possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4481definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4482values, and 0 otherwise.
4483
4484Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4485be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4486to indicate this.
4487@end deftypefn
4488
4489@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4490Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4491in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4492only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4493If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4494and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4495target hook.
4496
4497If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4498@end defmac
4499
4500@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4501This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4502address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4503passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4504be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4505hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4506argument.
4507
4508On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4509is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4510caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4511be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4512@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4513the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4514the caller.
4515
4516If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4517stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4518@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4519structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4520to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4521@end deftypefn
4522
4523@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4524Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4525for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4526the address of a static variable containing the value.
4527
4528Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4529pass an address to the subroutine.
4530
4531This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4532nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4533@end defmac
4534
ffa88471
SE
4535@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4536
4537@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4538
38f8b050
JR
4539@node Caller Saves
4540@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4541
4542If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4543makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4544must live across calls.
4545
4546@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4547A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4548a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4549restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4550this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4551
4552If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4553machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4554@end defmac
4555
4556@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4557A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4558of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4559@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4560returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4561will select the smallest suitable mode.
4562@end defmac
4563
4564@node Function Entry
4565@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4566@cindex function entry and exit
4567@cindex prologue
4568@cindex epilogue
4569
4570This section describes the macros that output function entry
4571(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4572
4573@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4574If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4575function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4576initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4577saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4578local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4579stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4580
4581The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4582macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4583
4584@findex regs_ever_live
4585To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4586@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4587@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4588prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4589call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4590@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4591
4592On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4593not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4594they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4595appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4596registers are used in the function.
4597
4598@findex frame_pointer_needed
4599On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4600function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4601pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4602frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4603@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4604time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4605
4606The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4607required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4608listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4609order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4610stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4611the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4612for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4613compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4614or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4615need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4616@end deftypefn
4617
4618@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4619If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4620prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4621emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4622emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4623@end deftypefn
4624
4625@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4626If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4627epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4628emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4629emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4630@end deftypefn
4631
4632@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4633If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4634function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4635registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4636called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4637same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4638registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4639@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4640
4641On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4642of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4643instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4644@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4645
4646Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4647@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4648switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4649define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4650target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4651condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4652
4653On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4654function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4655two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4656is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4657@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4658a function that needs a frame pointer.
4659
4660Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4661@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4662The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4663function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4664
4665On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4666others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4667given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4668number of arguments.
4669
4670@findex current_function_pops_args
4671Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4672functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4673needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4674function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4675@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4676@end deftypefn
4677
4678@itemize @bullet
4679@item
4680@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4681A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4682uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4683stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4684if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4685arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4686yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4687region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4688registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4689features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4690
4691@item
4692An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4693The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4694the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4695machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4696in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4697a save area.
4698
4699@item
4700A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4701boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4702this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4703save area closer to the top of the stack.
4704
4705@item
4706@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4707Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4708@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4709argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4710@end itemize
4711
4712@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4713Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4714instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4715pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4716adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4717default is 0.
4718
4719Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4720frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4721stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4722compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4723@end defmac
4724
4725@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4726Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4727used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4728pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4729@end defmac
4730
4731@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4732Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4733used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4734on entry to an exception edge.
4735@end defmac
4736
4737@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4738Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4739instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4740definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4741representing the number of delay slots there.
4742@end defmac
4743
4744@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4745A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4746slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4747
4748The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4749being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4750eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4751of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4752If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4753may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4754(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4755slot.
4756
4757@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4758@findex final_scan_insn
4759The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4760list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4761@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4762delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4763@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4764outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4765@code{final_scan_insn}.
4766
4767You need not define this macro if you did not define
4768@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4769@end defmac
4770
4771@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4772A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4773function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4774inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4775adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4776the real function.
4777
4778First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4779contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4780contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4781in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4782e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4783all other incoming arguments.
4784
4785Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4786made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4787adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4788
4789@smallexample
4790p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4791@end smallexample
4792
4793After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4794@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4795not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4796return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4797
4798The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4799the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4800of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4801and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4802
4803The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4804have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4805some targets, but probably not.
4806
4807If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4808front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4809@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4810not support varargs.
4811@end deftypefn
4812
4813@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4814A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4815to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4816arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4817generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4818previously exposed.
4819@end deftypefn
4820
4821@node Profiling
4822@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4823@cindex profiling, code generation
4824
4825These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4826
4827@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4828A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4829assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4830
4831@findex mcount
4832The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4833your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4834compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4835compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4836
4837Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4838variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4839@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4840the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4841@end defmac
4842
4843@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4844A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4845code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4846not support profiling.
4847@end defmac
4848
4849@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4850Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4851@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4852allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4853implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4854@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4855@end defmac
4856
4857@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4858Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4859the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4860@end defmac
4861
4862@node Tail Calls
4863@subsection Permitting tail calls
4864@cindex tail calls
4865
4866@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4867True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4868call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4869or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4870
4871It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4872tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4873during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4874as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4875``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4876may vary greatly between different architectures.
4877@end deftypefn
4878
4879@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4880Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4881function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4882cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4883registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4884TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4885FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4886@end deftypefn
4887
4888@node Stack Smashing Protection
4889@subsection Stack smashing protection
4890@cindex stack smashing protection
4891
4892@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4893This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4894for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4895runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4896that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4897variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4898
4899The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4900@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4901@end deftypefn
4902
4903@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4904This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4905stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4906involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4907
4908The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4909@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4910normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4911@end deftypefn
4912
7458026b
ILT
4913@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4914
38f8b050
JR
4915@node Varargs
4916@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4917@cindex varargs implementation
4918
4919GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4920@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4921on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4922varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4923conditionals to include it.
4924
4925ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4926the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4927implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4928to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4929@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4930supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4931
4932However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4933the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4934below.
4935
4936@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4937Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4938that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4939versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4940you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4941
4942On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4943control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4944other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4945found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4946
4947Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4948beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4949@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4950This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4951to use them for its own purposes.
4952@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4953@c 10feb93
4954@end defmac
4955
38f8b050 4956@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4957This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4958argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4959returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4960argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4961fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4962verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4963of the current function.
4964@end defmac
4965
4966@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4967Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4968passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4969has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4970specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4971with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4972
4973@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4974considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4975kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4976
4977The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4978interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4979@end defmac
4980
4981These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4982
4983@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4984If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4985@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4986beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4987return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4988to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4989@end deftypefn
4990
4991@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4992This target hook offers an alternative to using
4993@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4994@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4995register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4996have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4997use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4998pass all their arguments on the stack.
4999
5000The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5001structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5002named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5003last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5004
5005The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5006argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5007store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5008variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5009store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5010frame.
5011
5012Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5013compile time without knowing their data types,
5014@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5015have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5016for all data types.
5017
5018If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5019arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5020happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5021end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5022not generate any instructions in this case.
5023@end deftypefn
5024
5025@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5026Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5027argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5028
b25b9e8f 5029This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5030is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5031@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5032arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5033but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5034then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5035except the last are treated as named.
5036
5037You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5038@end deftypefn
5039
5040@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5041If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5042@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5043@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5044defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5045@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5046Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5047@end deftypefn
5048
5049@node Trampolines
5050@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5051@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5052@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5053
5054A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5055when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5056the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5057tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5058trampoline.
5059
5060The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5061address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5062the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5063two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5064exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5065machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5066two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5067operands.
5068
5069The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5070parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5071immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5072simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5073proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5074may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5075separately.
5076
5077@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5078This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5079on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5080the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5081label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5082
5083If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5084for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5085code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5086to generate it on the spot.
5087@end deftypefn
5088
5089@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5090Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5091(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5092@end defmac
5093
5094@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5095A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5096@end defmac
5097
5098@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5099Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5100
5101If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5102is used for aligning trampolines.
5103@end defmac
5104
5105@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5106This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5107@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5108is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5109RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5110when it is called.
5111
5112If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5113first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5114from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5115Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
38f8b050
JR
5116trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5117to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5118
5119If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5120enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
38f8b050
JR
5121initializing the trampoline proper.
5122@end deftypefn
5123
5124@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5125This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5126the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5127memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5128the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5129address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5130be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5131If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5132@end deftypefn
5133
5134Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5135separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5136fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5137jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5138
5139Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5140the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5141make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5142subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5143latter makes initialization faster.
5144
5145To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5146the following macro.
5147
5148@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5149If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5150cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5151typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5152@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5153@end defmac
5154
38f8b050
JR
5155To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5156you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5157cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5158beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5159its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5160
5161@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5162Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5163work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5164which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5165@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5166
5167If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5168C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5169special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5170statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5171global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5172special assembler code.
5173@end defmac
5174
5175@node Library Calls
5176@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5177@cindex library subroutine names
5178@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5179
5180@c prevent bad page break with this line
5181Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5182
5183@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5184This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5185expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5186provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5187are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5188@end defmac
5189
5190@findex set_optab_libfunc
5191@findex init_one_libfunc
5192@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5193This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5194existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5195@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5196@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5197library routines.
5198
5199The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5200@end deftypefn
5201
cdbf4541
BS
5202@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5203
38f8b050
JR
5204@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5205This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5206implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5207mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5208return a tristate.
5209
5210GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5211comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5212don't need to define this macro.
5213@end defmac
5214
5215@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5216This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5217functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5218operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5219and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5220If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5221@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5222in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5223@end defmac
5224
38f8b050
JR
5225@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5226@findex matherr
5227@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5228The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5229expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5230deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5231@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5232system.
5233
5234If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5235domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5236error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5237there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5238that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5239@end defmac
5240
5241@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5242@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5243Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5244refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5245@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5246macro, a reasonable default is used.
5247@end defmac
5248
5249@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5250@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5251When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5252@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5253default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5254functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5255systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5256@end defmac
5257
5258@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5259@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5260When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5261and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5262default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5263@smallexample
5264void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5265void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5266void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5267@end smallexample
5268@end defmac
5269
5270@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5271Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5272the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5273involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5274at once to the method-lookup library function.
5275
5276The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5277to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5278@end defmac
5279
5280@node Addressing Modes
5281@section Addressing Modes
5282@cindex addressing modes
5283
5284@c prevent bad page break with this line
5285This is about addressing modes.
5286
5287@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5288@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5289@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5290@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5291A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5292pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5293@end defmac
5294
5295@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5296@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5297A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5298post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5299the size of the memory operand.
5300@end defmac
5301
5302@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5303@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5304A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5305post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5306@end defmac
5307
5308@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5309A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5310is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5311@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5312is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5313constant addresses are supported.
38f8b050
JR
5314@end defmac
5315
5316@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5317@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5318accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5319known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5320expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5321@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5322@end defmac
5323
5324@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5325A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5326memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5327the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5328accept.
5329@end defmac
5330
5331@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5332A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5333address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5334
5335Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5336non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5337desired by the caller.
5338
5339The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5340that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5341considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5342kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5343must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5344up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5345register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5346if the array holds @code{-1}.
5347
5348The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5349accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5350register is required.
5351
5352Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5353and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5354constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5355specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5356recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5357
5358Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5359sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5360@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5361naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5362be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5363
5364@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5365On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5366the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5367target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5368into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5369@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5370@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5371Format}.
5372
5373@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5374Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5375this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5376has this syntax:
5377
5378@example
5379#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5380@end example
5381
5382@noindent
5383and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5384address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5385
5386@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5387Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5388macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5389@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5390that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5391
38f8b050
JR
5392Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5393files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5394@end deftypefn
5395
5396@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5397A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5398character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5399letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5400@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5401support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5402semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5403preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5404@code{'m'} constraint.
5405@end defmac
5406
5407@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5408A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5409or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5410can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5411@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5412
5413It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5414that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5415
5416The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5417a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5418@end defmac
5419
5420@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5421This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5422operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5423address.
5424
5425@findex break_out_memory_refs
5426@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5427and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5428@var{x}.
5429
5430The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5431@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5432should return the new @var{x}.
5433
5434It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5435The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5436is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5437a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5438strategy can generate better code.
5439@end deftypefn
5440
5441@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5442A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5443that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5444@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5445It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5446performance reasons.
5447
5448For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5449reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5450registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5451processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5452needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5453@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5454generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5455be shared.
5456
5457@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5458to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5459and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5460of reload internals.
5461
5462@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5463previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5464then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5465
5466@findex push_reload
5467The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5468need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5469suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5470
5471The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5472@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5473should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5474This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5475@code{push_reload}.
5476
5477@findex strict_memory_address_p
5478The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5479the address has become legitimate.
5480
5481@findex copy_rtx
5482If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5483this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5484single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5485top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5486It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5487address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5488@end defmac
5489
5490@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5491This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5492different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5493reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5494but not others.
5495
5496Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5497effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5498of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5499addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5500
5501You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5502
5503The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5504@end deftypefn
5505
5506@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5507A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5508@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5509different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5510reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5511but not others.
5512
5513Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5514effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5515of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5516addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5517
5518You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5519
5520These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5521@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5522@end defmac
5523
1a627b35
RS
5524@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5525This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5526@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5527@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5528
5529The default definition returns true.
5530@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
5531
5532@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5533This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5534@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5535macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5536references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5537addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5538the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5539into their original form.
5540@end deftypefn
5541
5542@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5543This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5544should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5545of @var{x}.
5546
5547The default version of this hook returns false.
38f8b050
JR
5548
5549The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5550deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5551from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5552holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5553of TLS symbols for various targets.
5554@end deftypefn
5555
5556@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5557This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5558be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5559of @var{x}.
5560
5561The default version returns false for all constants.
5562@end deftypefn
5563
89356d17 5564@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5565This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5566the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5567@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5568when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5569@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5570of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5571function are valid.
5572@end deftypefn
5573
5574@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5575This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5576address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5577used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5578@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5579
5580The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5581@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5582the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5583@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5584two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5585@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5586the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5587from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5588@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5589@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5590@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5591
5592If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5593to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5594use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5595@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5596should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5597described above.
5598If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5599the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5600log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5601@end deftypefn
5602
5603@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5604This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5605widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5606
5607If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5608@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5609widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5610preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5611@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5612@end deftypefn
5613
5614@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5615This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5616widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5617
5618If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5619@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5620widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5621preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5622@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5623@end deftypefn
5624
5625@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5626Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5627For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5628misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5629@end deftypefn
5630
5631@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5632Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5633@end deftypefn
5634
5635@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5636Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5637@end deftypefn
5638
5639@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5640Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5641@end deftypefn
5642
5643@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5644This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5645input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5646The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5647specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5648(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5649
5650If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5651@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5652conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5653@end deftypefn
5654
5655@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5656This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5657vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5658@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5659The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5660return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5661@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5662@end deftypefn
5663
5664@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5665This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5666store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5667parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5668the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5669parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5670@end deftypefn
5671
cc4b5170
RG
5672@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5673This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5674mode @var{mode}. The default is
5675equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5676transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5677@end deftypefn
5678
767f865f
RG
5679@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5680This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5681after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5682mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5683The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5684@end deftypefn
5685
38f8b050
JR
5686@node Anchored Addresses
5687@section Anchored Addresses
5688@cindex anchored addresses
5689@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5690
5691GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5692For example, if we have:
5693
5694@smallexample
5695static int a, b, c;
5696int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5697@end smallexample
5698
5699the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5700addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5701it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5702the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5703be something like:
5704
5705@smallexample
5706int foo (void)
5707@{
5708 register int *xr = &x;
5709 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5710@}
5711@end smallexample
5712
5713(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5714``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5715
5716The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5717in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5718section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5719or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5720
5721@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5722The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5723On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5724applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5725for every mode. The default value is 0.
5726@end deftypevr
5727
5728@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5729Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5730offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5731value is 0.
5732@end deftypevr
5733
5734@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5735Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5736@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5737The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5738of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5739
5740If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5741it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5742If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5743is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5744@end deftypefn
5745
5746@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5747Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5748@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5749@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5750
5751The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5752intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5753or target-specific sections.
5754@end deftypefn
5755
5756@node Condition Code
5757@section Condition Code Status
5758@cindex condition code status
5759
5760The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5761two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5762
5763The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5764(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5765clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5766register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5767architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5768most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5769most RISC machines.
5770
5771The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5772the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5773insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5774optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5775is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5776three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5777scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5778separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5779
5780For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5781represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5782condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5783condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5784or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5785Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5786that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5787
5788Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5789specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5790interested in most macros in this section.
5791
5792@menu
5793* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5794* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5795* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5796@end menu
5797
5798@node CC0 Condition Codes
5799@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5800@findex cc0
5801
5802@findex cc_status
5803The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5804describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5805the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5806variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5807currently based, and several standard flags.
5808
5809Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5810description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5811information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5812
5813@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5814C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5815component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5816
5817This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5818@end defmac
5819
5820@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5821A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5822The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5823the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5824define this macro to initialize it.
5825
5826This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5827@end defmac
5828
5829@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5830A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5831appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5832this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5833code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5834set @code{(cc0)}.
5835
5836This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5837
5838If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5839other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5840invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5841reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5842registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5843@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5844insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5845based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5846value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5847this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5848@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5849@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5850condition code value.
5851
5852The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5853with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5854@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5855constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5856insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5857@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5858@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5859
5860A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5861that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5862@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5863two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5864@end defmac
5865
5866@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5867@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5868@findex CCmode
5869@findex MODE_CC
5870
5871@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5872On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5873than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5874code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5875when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5876bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5877branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5878this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5879record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5880also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5881unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5882
5883If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5884@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5885a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5886have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5887by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5888be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5889the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5890
5891@smallexample
5892(define_insn ""
5893 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5894 (compare:CC_NOOV
5895 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5896 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5897 (const_int 0)))]
5898 ""
5899 "@dots{}")
5900@end smallexample
5901
5902@noindent
5903together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5904for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5905
5906@smallexample
5907#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5908 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5909 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5910 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5911 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5912 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5913@end smallexample
5914
5915Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5916were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5917this section.
5918
5919You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5920in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5921@end defmac
5922
5923@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5924On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5925convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5926does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5927comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5928
5929On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5930required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5931and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5932comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5933@var{op1} as required.
5934
5935GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5936valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5937@file{md} file.
5938
5939You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5940code or operands.
5941@end defmac
5942
5943@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5944A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5945comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5946can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5947then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5948
5949You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5950floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5951For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5952inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5953
5954@smallexample
5955#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5956@end smallexample
5957@end defmac
5958
5959@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5960A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5961comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5962@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5963machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5964instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5965freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5966like:
5967
5968@smallexample
5969#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5970 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5971 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5972@end smallexample
5973@end defmac
5974
5975@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
5976On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
5977register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
5978regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
5979hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
5980small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
5981to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
5982arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
5983When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
5984integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
5985@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
5986
5987The default version of this hook returns false.
5988@end deftypefn
5989
5990@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
5991On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
5992@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
5993validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
5994target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
5995both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
5996return @code{VOIDmode}.
5997
5998The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
5999same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6000returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6001@end deftypefn
6002
ac7eb5c6 6003@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
6004@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6005@findex conditional execution
6006@findex predication
6007
6008There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6009supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6010represent conditional branches.
6011
6012@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6013A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6014@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6015versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6016predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6017that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6018If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6019
6020@smallexample
6021#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6022 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6023@end smallexample
6024@end defmac
6025
6026@node Costs
6027@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6028@cindex costs of instructions
6029@cindex relative costs
6030@cindex speed of instructions
6031
6032These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6033on the target machine.
6034
6035@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6036A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6037register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6038expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6039value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6040that.
6041
6042It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6043same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6044registers if they are not general registers.
6045
6046If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6047hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6048classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6049constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6050allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6051if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6052
6053These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6054@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6055@end defmac
6056
6057@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6058This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6059from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6060are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6061A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6062that.
6063
6064It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6065same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6066registers if they are not general registers.
6067
6068If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6069hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6070classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6071constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6072allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6073if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6074
6075The default version of this function returns 2.
6076@end deftypefn
6077
6078@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6079A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6080register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6081is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6082is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6083registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6084should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6085
6086If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6087the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6088needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6089between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6090more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6091reflect the actual cost of the move.
6092
6093GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6094secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6095a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6096secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
60974 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6098value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6099are the same as to this macro.
6100
6101These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6102@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6103@end defmac
6104
911852ff 6105@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6106This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6107between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6108if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6109This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6110If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6111registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6112
6113If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6114the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6115needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6116between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6117more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6118reflect the actual cost of the move.
6119
6120GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6121secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6122a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6123secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61244 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6125value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6126are the same as to this target hook.
6127@end deftypefn
6128
6129@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6130A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6131the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6132@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6133for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6134optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6135true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6136@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6137@end defmac
6138
6139Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6140but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6141ordinarily expect.
6142
6143@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6144Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6145than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6146faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6147require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6148between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6149
6150When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6151finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6152load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6153faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6154may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6155other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6156@end defmac
6157
6158@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6159Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6160@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6161than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6162handler.
6163
6164When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6165@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6166moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6167Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6168cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6169
6170If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6171this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6172@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6173@end defmac
6174
6175@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6176The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6177which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6178string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6179make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6180
6181Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6182@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6183the number of such sequences.
6184
6185The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6186optimized for speed rather than size.
6187
6188If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6189@end defmac
6190
6191@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6192A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6193copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6194will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6195than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6196@end defmac
6197
6198@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6199A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6200a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6201@end defmac
6202
6203@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6204The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6205of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6206or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6207eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6208
6209The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6210optimized for speed rather than size.
6211
6212If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6213@end defmac
6214
6215@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6216A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6217to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6218will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6219than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6220@end defmac
6221
6222@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6223The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6224of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6225a block set insn or a library call.
38f8b050
JR
6226Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6227eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6228
6229The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6230optimized for speed rather than size.
6231
6232If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6233@end defmac
6234
6235@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6236A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6237used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6238other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
38f8b050
JR
6239storing values other than constant zero.
6240Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6241than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6242@end defmac
6243
6244@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6245A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6246used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6247other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6248called with a constant source string.
6249Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6250than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6251@end defmac
6252
6253@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6254A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6255thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6256@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6257@end defmac
6258
6259@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6260A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6261thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6262@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6263@end defmac
6264
6265@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6266A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6267thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6268@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6269@end defmac
6270
6271@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6272A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6273thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6274@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6275@end defmac
6276
6277@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6278A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6279thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6280@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6281@end defmac
6282
6283@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6284A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6285thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6286@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6287@end defmac
6288
6289@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6290This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6291thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6292@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6293@end defmac
6294
6295@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6296This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6297thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6298@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6299@end defmac
6300
6301@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6302Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6303function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6304@end defmac
6305
6306@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6307Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6308@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6309@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6310@end defmac
6311
6312@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6313This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6314
6315The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6316available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6317in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6318expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6319@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6320
6321In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6322@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6323instructions.
6324
6325On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6326for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6327necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6328for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6329operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6330
6331When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6332false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6333size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6334
6335The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6336processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6337@end deftypefn
6338
6339@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6340This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6341@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6342the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6343
6344For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6345true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6346instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6347all addresses will have equal costs.
6348
6349In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6350the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6351cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6352
6353For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6354and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6355is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6356references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6357the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6358that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6359instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6360specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6361
6362This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6363
6364On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6365cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6366@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6367be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6368@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6369should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6370should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6371registers on machines with lots of registers.
6372@end deftypefn
6373
6374@node Scheduling
6375@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6376
6377The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6378adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6379hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6380them: try the first ones in this list first.
6381
6382@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6383This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6384issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6385Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6386an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6387constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6388hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6389This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6390it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6391@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6392@end deftypefn
6393
6394@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6395This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6396from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6397still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6398@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6399@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6400You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6401than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6402@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6403debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6404@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6405was scheduled.
6406@end deftypefn
6407
6408@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6409This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6410relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6411dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6412is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6413to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6414that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6415data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6416description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6417output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6418times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6419acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6420@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6421@end deftypefn
6422
6423@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6424This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6425@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6426execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6427later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6428scheduling priorities of insns.
6429@end deftypefn
6430
6431@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6432This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6433list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6434combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6435@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6436debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6437@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6438list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6439a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6440reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6441@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6442is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6443the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6444can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6445@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6446@end deftypefn
6447
6448@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6449Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6450function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6451is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6452@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6453return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6454this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6455scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6456cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6457@end deftypefn
6458
6459@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6460This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6461chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6462correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6463example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6464analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6465dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6466calculated.
6467@end deftypefn
6468
6469@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6470This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6471instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6472pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6473is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6474@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6475region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6476scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6477@end deftypefn
6478
6479@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6480This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6481instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6482cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6483is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6484to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6485@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6486@end deftypefn
6487
6488@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6489This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6490@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6491@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6492@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6493@end deftypefn
6494
6495@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6496This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6497@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6498@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6499@end deftypefn
6500
6501@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6502The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6503pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6504when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6505simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6506processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6507based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6508when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6509@end deftypefn
6510
6511@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6512The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6513@end deftypefn
6514
6515@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6516The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6517to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6518simulated processor cycle finishes.
6519@end deftypefn
6520
6521@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6522The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6523used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6524@end deftypefn
6525
6526@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6527The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6528The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6529to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6530state on a single insn is not enough.
6531@end deftypefn
6532
6533@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6534The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6535The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6536to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6537state on a single insn is not enough.
6538@end deftypefn
6539
6540@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6541This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6542for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6543chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6544value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6545@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6546subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6547maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6548@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6549packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6550rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6551
6552This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6553processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6554with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6555@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6556@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6557processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6558@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6559until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6560the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6561
6562Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6563pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6564schedules to choose the best one.
6565
6566The default is no multipass scheduling.
6567@end deftypefn
6568
6569@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6570
6571This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6572considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6573zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6574be issued.
6575
6576The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6577@end deftypefn
6578
894fd6f2
MK
6579@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6580This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6581scheduling.
6582@end deftypefn
6583
6584@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6585This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6586@end deftypefn
6587
6588@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6589This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6590an instruction.
6591@end deftypefn
6592
6593@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6594This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6595round of multipass scheduling.
6596@end deftypefn
6597
6598@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6599This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6600@end deftypefn
6601
6602@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6603This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6604@end deftypefn
6605
c06bbdf7 6606@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6607This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6608on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6609@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6610the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6611is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6612start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6613verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6614@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6615processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6616and the current processor cycle.
6617@end deftypefn
6618
6619@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6620This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6621the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6622are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6623to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6624being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6625dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6626parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6627The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6628insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6629and @code{false} otherwise.
6630
6631Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6632where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6633delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6634that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6635important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6636closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6637not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6638@end deftypefn
6639
6640@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6641This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6642the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6643per instruction data structures.
6644@end deftypefn
6645
6646@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6647Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6648@end deftypefn
6649
6650@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6651Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6652It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6653beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6654@end deftypefn
6655
6656@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6657Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6658@end deftypefn
6659
6660@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6661Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6662@end deftypefn
6663
6664@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6665Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6666@end deftypefn
6667
6668@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6669This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6670speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6671The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6672version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6673pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6674or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6675speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6676the generated speculative pattern.
6677@end deftypefn
6678
6679@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6680This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6681for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6682instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6683@end deftypefn
6684
6685@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6686This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6687check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6688speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6689@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6690be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6691recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6692a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6693@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6694@end deftypefn
6695
6696@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6697This hook is used as a workaround for
6698@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6699called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6700discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6701being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6702@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6703For non-speculative instructions,
6704the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6705the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6706is nearly full.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6710This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6711enabled/used.
6712The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6713The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6714@end deftypefn
6715
6716@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6717This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6718resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6719the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6720backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6721bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6722of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6723@end deftypefn
6724
7942e47e
RY
6725@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6726This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6727is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6728@end deftypefn
6729
6730@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6731This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6732in its second parameter.
6733@end deftypefn
6734
b0bd15f7
BS
6735@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6736
38f8b050
JR
6737@node Sections
6738@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6739@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6740@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6741
6742An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6743data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6744section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6745section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6746section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6747of sections.
6748
6749@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6750@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6751The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6752is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6753as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6754initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6755They may however depend on command-line flags.
6756
6757@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6758use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6759to be string literals.
6760
6761Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6762section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6763should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6764@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6765
6766You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6767@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6768in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6769@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6770create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6771reuse @code{text_section}.
6772
6773All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6774if the target does not provide them.
6775
6776@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6777A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6778assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6779Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6780@end defmac
6781
6782@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6783If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6784frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6785a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6786@end defmac
6787
6788@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6789If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6790executed functions in the program.
6791@end defmac
6792
6793@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6794A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6795assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6796data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6797@end defmac
6798
6799@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6800If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6801containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6802initialized, writable small data.
6803@end defmac
6804
6805@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6806A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6807assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6808data.
6809@end defmac
6810
6811@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6812If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6813containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6814uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6815@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6816uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6817@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6818used.
6819@end defmac
6820
6821@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6822If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6823containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6824uninitialized, writable small data.
6825@end defmac
6826
6827@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6828If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6829assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6830common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6831@end defmac
6832
6833@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6834If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6835containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6836default is @code{'T'}.
6837@end defmac
6838
6839@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6840If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6841containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6842initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6843not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6844variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6845@end defmac
6846
6847@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6848If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6849containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6850finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6851not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6852variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6853@end defmac
6854
6855@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6856If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6857containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6858part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6859defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6860both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6861@end defmac
6862
6863@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6864If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6865containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6866part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6867defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6868both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6872If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6873via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6874the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6875@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6876to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6877sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6878ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6879registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6880constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6881@end defmac
6882
6883@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6884If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6885variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6886when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6887you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6888they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6889expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6890MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6891require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6892to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6893access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6894@end defmac
6895
6896@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6897If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6898arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6899@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6900and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6901@end defmac
6902
6903@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6904Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6905tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6906section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6907readonly data section is used.
6908
6909This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6910@end defmac
6911
6912@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6913Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6914@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6915of its own that you need to create.
6916
6917GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6918any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6919described below.
6920@end deftypefn
6921
6922@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6923Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6924selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6925should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6926local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6927
6928The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6929is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6930when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6931in read-only sections even in executables.
6932@end deftypefn
6933
6934@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6935Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6936assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6937some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6938requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6939local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6940@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6941
6942The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6943variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6944
6945See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6946@end deftypefn
6947
6948@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6949Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6950for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6951
6952In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6953function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6954it is unlikely to be called.
6955@end defmac
6956
6957@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6958Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6959and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6960As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6961the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6962
6963The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6964ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6965example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6966Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6967@end deftypefn
6968
6969@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
6970Return the readonly data section associated with
6971@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6972The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
6973the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
6974if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
6975otherwise.
6976@end deftypefn
6977
6978@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
6979Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
6980should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6981constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6982case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
6983in bits.
6984
6985The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6986constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6987else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6988@end deftypefn
6989
6990@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
6991Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
6992by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
6993the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
6994or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
6995hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
6996your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
6997returns the @var{id} provided.
6998@end deftypefn
6999
7000@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7001Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7002treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7003function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7004
7005The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7006@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7007an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7008rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7009in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7010
7011In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7012a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7013will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7014register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7015rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7016leave it alone.)
7017
7018The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7019that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7020be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7021declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7022declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7023@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7024
7025@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7026The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7027@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7028Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7029encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7030discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7031
7032The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7033in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7034@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7035before overriding it.
7036@end deftypefn
7037
7038@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7039Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7040the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7041may have added.
7042@end deftypefn
7043
7044@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7045Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7046The default version of this hook always returns false.
7047@end deftypefn
7048
7049@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7050Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7051``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7052@end deftypevr
7053
3c5273a9
KT
7054@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7055
38f8b050
JR
7056@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7057Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7058rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7059or executable image).
7060
7061The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7062for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7063currently supported object file formats.
7064@end deftypefn
7065
7066@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7067Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7068The default value is false.
7069@end deftypevr
7070
7071
7072@node PIC
7073@section Position Independent Code
7074@cindex position independent code
7075@cindex PIC
7076
7077This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7078independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7079generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7080@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7081@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7082must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7083when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7084need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7085relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7086@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
38f8b050
JR
7087@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7088
7089@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7090The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7091data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7092processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7093is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7094pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7095is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7096necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7097when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7098@end defmac
7099
7100@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7101A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7102@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7103the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7104this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7105@end defmac
7106
7107@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7108A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7109operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7110You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7111check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7112check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7113(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7114position independent code.
7115@end defmac
7116
7117@node Assembler Format
7118@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7119
7120This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7121to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7122instructions do.
7123
7124@menu
7125* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7126* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7127* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7128* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7129* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7130 and termination routines.
7131* Macros for Initialization::
7132 Specific macros that control the handling of
7133 initialization and termination routines.
7134* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7135* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7136* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7137* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7138@end menu
7139
7140@node File Framework
7141@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7142@cindex assembler format
7143@cindex output of assembler code
7144
7145@c prevent bad page break with this line
7146This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7147
7148@findex default_file_start
7149@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7150Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7151find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7152by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7153quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7154@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7155lets other target files rely on these variables.
7156@end deftypefn
7157
7158@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7159If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7160printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7161@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7162to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7163definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7164assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7165whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7166
7167The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7168verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7169comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7170@end deftypevr
7171
7172@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7173If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7174for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7175@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7176this to be done. The default is false.
7177@end deftypevr
7178
7179@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7180Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7181to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7182@end deftypefn
7183
7184@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7185Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7186special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7187the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7188should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7189need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7190this function.
7191@end deftypefun
7192
7193@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7194Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7195to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7196nothing.
7197@end deftypefn
7198
7199@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7200Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7201to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7202nothing.
7203@end deftypefn
7204
7205@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7206Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7207unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7208here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7209because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7210nothing.
7211@end deftypefn
7212
7213@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7214A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7215assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7216the end of the line.
7217@end defmac
7218
7219@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7220A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7221statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7222@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7223assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7224that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7225@end defmac
7226
7227@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7228A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7229statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7230@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7231time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7232@end defmac
7233
7234@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7235A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7236which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7237the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7238
7239This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7240for the file format in use is appropriate.
7241@end defmac
7242
b5f5d41d
AS
7243@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7244
38f8b050
JR
7245@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7246A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7247@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7248in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7249the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7250of the filename using this macro.
7251@end defmac
7252
7253@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7254A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7255@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7256macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7257@end defmac
7258
7259@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7260Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7261should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7262of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7263is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7264this section is associated.
7265@end deftypefn
7266
f16d3f39
JH
7267@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7268Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7269Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7270functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7271at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7272@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7273(from static destructors).
7274Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7275@end deftypefn
7276
14d11d40
IS
7277@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7278
38f8b050
JR
7279@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7280This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7281It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7282@end deftypevr
7283
7284@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7285@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7286This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7287section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7288This is true on most ELF targets.
7289@end deftypevr
7290
7291@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7292Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7293based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7294declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7295null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7296
7297The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7298read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7299need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7300set via @code{__attribute__}.
7301@end deftypefn
7302
7303@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7304Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7305switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7306enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7307It can take the following values:
7308
7309@table @gcctabopt
7310@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7311@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7312
7313@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7314@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7315direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7316default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7317command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7318various different individual optimization passes.
7319
7320@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7321@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7322ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7323target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7324time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7325warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7326wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7327necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7328perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7329switches.
7330
7331@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7332This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7333
7334@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7335This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7336@end table
7337
7338The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7339supported in the future.
7340
7341By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7342provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7343it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7344section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7345provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7346hook.
7347@end deftypefn
7348
7349@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7350This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7351ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7352hook.
7353@end deftypevr
7354
7355@need 2000
7356@node Data Output
7357@subsection Output of Data
7358
7359
7360@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7361@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7362@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7363@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7364@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7365@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7366@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7367@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7368@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7369These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7370of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7371byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7372aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7373@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7374
7375The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7376followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7377the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7378@end deftypevr
7379
7380@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7381The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7382integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7383in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7384function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7385object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7386split the object into smaller parts.
7387
7388The default implementation of this hook will use the
7389@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7390when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7391@end deftypefn
7392
6cbd8875
AS
7393@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7394A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7395can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7396the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7397@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7398
7399If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7400so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7401itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7402return @code{true}.
7403@end deftypefn
7404
38f8b050
JR
7405@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7406A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7407@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7408@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7409allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7410
7411If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7412@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7413prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7414@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7415@end defmac
7416
7417@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7418A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7419instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7420bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7421@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7422
7423If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7424Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7425@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7426@end defmac
7427
7428@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7429A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7430@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7431is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7432@end defmac
7433
7434@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7435You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7436expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7437pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7438GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7439not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7440pool before the function.
7441@end defmac
7442
7443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7444A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7445constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7446the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7447be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7448is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7449immediately after this call.
7450
7451If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7452not be defined.
7453@end defmac
7454
7455@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7456A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7457constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7458anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7459
7460The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7461assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7462output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7463@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7464@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7465alignment.
7466
7467The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7468the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7469responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7470Here is how to do this:
7471
7472@smallexample
7473@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7474@end smallexample
7475
7476When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7477@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7478entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7479
7480You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7481@end defmac
7482
7483@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7484A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7485pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7486function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7487obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7488constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7489
7490If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7491define this macro.
7492@end defmac
7493
7494@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7495Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7496used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7497to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7498a line separator uses multiple characters.
7499
7500If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7501the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7502@end defmac
7503
7504@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7505These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7506assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7507default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7508@end deftypevr
7509
7510These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7511of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7512
7513@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7514@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7515@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7516@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7517@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7518@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7519These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7520target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7521the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7522@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7523simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7524@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7525by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7526it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
752732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7528on the host machine.
7529
7530The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7531using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7532machine's memory.
7533@end defmac
7534
7535@node Uninitialized Data
7536@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7537
7538Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7539outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7540
7541@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7542A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7543@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7544@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7545is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7546possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7547other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7548backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7549byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7550equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7551the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7552an ordinary undefined external.
7553
7554Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7555output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7556assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7557
7558This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7559common global variables are output.
7560@end defmac
7561
7562@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7563Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7564separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7565place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7566handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7567as the number of bits.
7568@end defmac
7569
7570@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7571Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7572variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7573is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7574in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7575@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7576the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7577@end defmac
7578
07c5f94e 7579@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7580A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7581@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7582@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7583is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7584
07c5f94e
AS
7585Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7586@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7587@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7588before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7589the name, and a newline.
7590
07c5f94e 7591There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7592The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7593switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7594You do not need to do both.
7595
7596Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7597non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7598efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7599not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7600common in order to save space in the object file.
7601@end defmac
7602
38f8b050
JR
7603@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7604A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7605@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7606@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7607is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7608
7609Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7610output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7611assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7612
7613This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7614static variables are output.
7615@end defmac
7616
7617@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7618Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7619separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7620place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7621handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7622as the number of bits.
7623@end defmac
7624
7625@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7626Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7627variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7628is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7629in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7630@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7631the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7632@end defmac
7633
7634@node Label Output
7635@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7636
7637@c prevent bad page break with this line
7638This is about outputting labels.
7639
7640@findex assemble_name
7641@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7642A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7643@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7644Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7645output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7646assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7647definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7648@end defmac
7649
135a687e
KT
7650@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7651A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7652@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7653a function.
7654Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7655output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7656assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7657definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7658
7659If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7660usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7661@end defmac
7662
38f8b050
JR
7663@findex assemble_name_raw
7664@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7665Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7666to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7667@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7668that it is more efficient.
7669@end defmac
7670
7671@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7672A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7673size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7674default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7675systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7676
7677Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7678of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7679for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7680macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7681define this macro.
7682@end defmac
7683
7684@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7685A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7686@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7687symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7688If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7689provided.
7690@end defmac
7691
7692@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7693A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7694@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7695the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7696address.
7697
7698If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7699provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7700@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7701the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7702not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7703to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7704@end defmac
7705
7706@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7707A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7708type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7709default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7710systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7711
7712Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7713@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7714custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7715types at all, do not define this macro.
7716@end defmac
7717
7718@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7719A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7720the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7721default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7722the default is not to define this macro.
7723
7724Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7725@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7726custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7727types at all, do not define this macro.
7728@end defmac
7729
7730@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7731A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7732@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7733symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7734that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7735you should not count on this.
7736
7737If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7738definition of this macro is provided.
7739@end defmac
7740
7741@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7742A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7743@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7744function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7745outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7746@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7747@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7748
7749If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7750usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7751
7752You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7753of this macro.
7754@end defmac
7755
7756@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7757A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7758@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7759which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7760function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7761representing the function.
7762
7763If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7764
7765You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7766of this macro.
7767@end defmac
7768
7769@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7770A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7771@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7772initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7773label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7774@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7775
7776If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7777usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7778
7779You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7780@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7781@end defmac
7782
ad78130c 7783@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7784A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7785for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7786target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7787@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7788and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7789will be an internal label.
7790
7791The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7792usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7793
7794You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7795@end deftypefn
7796
7797@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7798A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7799@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7800for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7801
7802If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7803nothing.
7804@end defmac
7805
7806@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7807A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7808once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7809chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7810initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7811something about the size of the object.
7812
7813If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7814nothing.
7815
7816You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7817@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7818@end defmac
7819
7820@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7821This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7822@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7823that is, available for reference from other files.
7824
7825The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7826@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7827@end deftypefn
7828
7829@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7830This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7831@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7832global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7833
7834The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7835@end deftypefn
7836
7837@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7838A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7839@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7840that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7841no other definition is available. Use the expression
7842@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7843itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7844for making that name weak, and a newline.
7845
7846If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7847support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7848macro.
7849@end defmac
7850
7851@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7852Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7853@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7854or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7855should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7856defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7857@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7858to make @var{name} weak.
7859@end defmac
7860
7861@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7862Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7863symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7864declaration of @code{name}.
7865@end defmac
7866
7867@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7868A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7869supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7870
7871If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7872definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7873is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7874@end defmac
7875
7876@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7877A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7878
7879If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7880definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7881this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7882flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7883@end defmac
7884
7885@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7886A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7887public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7888be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7889format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7890section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7891requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7892@end defmac
7893
7894@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7895A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7896semantics.
7897
7898If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7899definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7900definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7901you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7902setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7903be emitted as one-only.
7904@end defmac
7905
7906@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7907This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7908commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7909hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7910@end deftypefn
7911
7912@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7913A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7914that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7915The default is @code{0}.
7916
7917Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7918if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7919will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7920symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7921thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7922(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7923with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7924
7925The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7926targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7927restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7928table of contents.
7929@end defmac
7930
7931@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7932A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7933@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7934symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7935not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7936declaration.
7937
7938This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7939The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7940@end defmac
7941
7942@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7943This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7944pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7945library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7946@end deftypefn
7947
7948@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7949This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7950directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7951.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7952@end deftypefn
7953
7954@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7955A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7956@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7957@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7958is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7959systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7960@end defmac
7961
77754180
DK
7962@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7963
38f8b050
JR
7964@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7965A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7966@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7967will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7968to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7969encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7970@end defmac
7971
7972@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7973A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7974result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7975@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7976This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7977specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7978when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7979being taken.
7980@end defmac
7981
7982@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
7983A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
7984name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
7985
7986It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
7987used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
7988will have name conflicts with internal labels.
7989
7990It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
7991object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
7992should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
7993beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
7994convention your system uses, and follow it.
7995
7996The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
7997@end deftypefn
7998
7999@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8000A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8001label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8002@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8003may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8004systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8005bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8006bundles.
8007
8008If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8009used.
8010@end defmac
8011
8012@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8013A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8014is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8015
8016This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8017produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8018with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8019
8020If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8021output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8022@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8023string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8024to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8025@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8026you should know what it does on your machine.)
8027@end defmac
8028
8029@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8030A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8031@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8032@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8033added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8034
8035The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8036produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8037@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8038assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8039macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8040internal static variables in different scopes.
8041
8042Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8043conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8044or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8045between the name and the number will suffice.
8046
8047If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8048which is correct for most systems.
8049@end defmac
8050
8051@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8052A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8053which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8054
8055@findex SET_ASM_OP
8056If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8057correct for most systems.
8058@end defmac
8059
8060@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8061A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8062which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8063to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8064be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8065the tree nodes are available.
8066
8067@findex SET_ASM_OP
8068If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8069correct for most systems.
8070@end defmac
8071
8072@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8073A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8074(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8075of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8076current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8077This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8078@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8079@end defmac
8080
8081@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8082A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8083which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8084@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8085an undefined weak symbol.
8086
8087Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8088@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8089@end defmac
8090
8091@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8092Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8093Objective-C methods.
8094
8095The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8096class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8097the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8098@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8099
8100These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8101the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8102systems define other ways of computing names.
8103
8104@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8105buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8106@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
810750 characters extra.
8108
8109The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8110method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8111@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8112in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8113
8114On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8115macro to provide more human-readable names.
8116@end defmac
8117
8118@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8119A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8120@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8121Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8122linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8123@end defmac
8124
8125@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8126A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8127@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8128unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8129whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8130@end defmac
8131
8132@node Initialization
8133@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8134@cindex initialization routines
8135@cindex termination routines
8136@cindex constructors, output of
8137@cindex destructors, output of
8138
8139The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8140(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8141data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8142to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8143@code{main} is called.
8144
8145Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8146@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8147terminates.
8148
8149To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8150must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8151be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8152system, you need to specify how to do this.
8153
8154There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8155initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8156Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8157
8158@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8159@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8160The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8161initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8162termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8163
8164Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81650, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8166the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8167pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8168pointer containing zero.
8169
8170Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8171@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8172time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8173list; destructors in forward order.
8174
8175The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8176formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8177aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8178Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8179object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8180the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8181accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8182Termination functions are handled similarly.
8183
8184This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8185@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8186support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8187constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8188and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8189
8190When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8191upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8192support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8193parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8194program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8195
8196@smallexample
8197ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8198@end smallexample
8199
8200The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8201section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8202for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8203files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8204are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8205
8206The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8207compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8208fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8209to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8210of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8211that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8212
8213To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8214macro properly.
8215
8216If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8217@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8218entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8219it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8220after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8221in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8222
8223In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8224two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8225and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8226@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8227entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8228and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8229code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8230the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8231placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8232a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8233@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8234section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8235the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8236the initialization process.
8237
8238The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8239This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8240file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8241this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8242termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8243an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8244pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8245the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8246initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8247via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8248@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8249
8250@ifinfo
8251The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8252customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8253@end ifinfo
8254
8255@node Macros for Initialization
8256@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8257
8258Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8259and termination functions:
8260
8261@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8262If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8263operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8264defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8265using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8266macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8267run the initialization functions.
8268@end defmac
8269
8270@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8271If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8272This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8273on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8274be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8275@end defmac
8276
8277@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8278If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8279the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8280@end defmac
8281
8282@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8283If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8284the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8285@end defmac
8286
8287@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8288If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8289automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8290should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8291the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8292function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8293
8294This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8295shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8296exception tables embedded in the code.
8297@end defmac
8298
8299@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8300If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8301automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8302should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8303the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8304function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8305@end defmac
8306
8307@defmac INVOKE__main
8308If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8309@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8310where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8311useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8312@end defmac
8313
8314@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8315If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8316compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8317of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8318encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8319@end defmac
8320
8321@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8322This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8323collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8324It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8325@end deftypevr
8326
8327@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8328If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8329the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8330
8331Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8332no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8333priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8334otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8335
8336If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8337be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8338target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8339is not defined.
8340@end deftypefn
8341
8342@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8343This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8344functions rather than initialization functions.
8345@end deftypefn
8346
8347If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8348generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8349
8350If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8351constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8352an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8353
8354On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8355@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8356
8357@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8358Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8359object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8360object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8361
8362This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8363part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8364@end defmac
8365
8366@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8367Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8368to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8369@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8370@end defmac
8371
8372@defmac NM_FLAGS
8373@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8374constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8375passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8376are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8377produces.
8378@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8379
8380If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8381dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8382these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8383termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8384
8385@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8386Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8387which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8388@end defmac
8389
8390@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8391Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8392of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8393of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8394from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8395code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8396line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8397@end defmac
8398
8399@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8400Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8401library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8402strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8403constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8404that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@node Instruction Output
8408@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8409
8410@c prevent bad page break with this line
8411This describes assembler instruction output.
8412
8413@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8414A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8415registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8416register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8417@end defmac
8418
8419@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8420If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8421and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8422registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8423to registers using alternate names.
8424@end defmac
8425
0c6d290e
RE
8426@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8427If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8428name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8429machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8430names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8431declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8432@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8433register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8434
8435This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8436@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8437register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8438VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8439``s0'' and ``s1''.
8440@end defmac
8441
38f8b050
JR
8442@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8443Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8444requires different names for the machine instructions.
8445
8446The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8447assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8448macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8449points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8450written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8451opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8452increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8453so that it will not be output twice.
8454
8455In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8456name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8457that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8458care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8459@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8460
8461@findex recog_data.operand
8462If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8463elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8464
8465If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8466in the usual way.
8467@end defmac
8468
8469@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8470If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8471assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8472they will be output differently.
8473
8474Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8475extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8476elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8477The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8478template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8479by changing the contents of the vector.
8480
8481This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8482file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8483can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8484as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8485syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8486writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8487
8488If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8489@end defmac
8490
8491@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8492If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8493output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8494if necessary.
8495
8496Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8497extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8498elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8499The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8500template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8501by checking the contents of the vector.
8502@end deftypefn
8503
8504@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8505A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8506assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8507RTL expression.
8508
8509@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8510of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8511printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8512the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8513operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8514@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8515@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8516
8517@findex reg_names
8518If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8519The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8520@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8521@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8522
8523When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8524(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8525with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8526@var{code}.
8527@end defmac
8528
8529@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8530A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8531punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8532@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8533punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8534in this way.
8535@end defmac
8536
8537@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8538A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8539assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8540whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8541
8542@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8543On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8544section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8545@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8546@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8547Format}.
8548@end defmac
8549
8550@findex dbr_sequence_length
8551@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8552A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8553been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8554determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8555currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8556or whatever.
8557
8558Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8559reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8560explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8561@end defmac
8562
8563@findex final_sequence
8564Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8565prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8566(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8567found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8568processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8569being output.
8570
8571@findex asm_fprintf
8572@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8573@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8574@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8575@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8576If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8577@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8578@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8579support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8580files can define these macros differently.
8581@end defmac
8582
8583@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8584If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8585statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8586the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8587printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8588statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8589generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8590specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8591The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8592string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8593upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8594@end defmac
8595
8596@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8597If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8598different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8599numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8600first variant.
8601
8602If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8603@smallexample
8604@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8605@end smallexample
8606@noindent
8607in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8608first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8609@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8610@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8611within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8612alternatives within the braces than the value of
8613@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8614
8615If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8616@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8617operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8618
8619Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8620@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8621the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8622@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8623if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8624opcodes or operand order.
8625@end defmac
8626
8627@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8628A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8629which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8630The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8631profiling.
8632@end defmac
8633
8634@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8635A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8636which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8637The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8638profiling.
8639@end defmac
8640
8641@node Dispatch Tables
8642@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8643
8644@c prevent bad page break with this line
8645This concerns dispatch tables.
8646
8647@cindex dispatch table
8648@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8649A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8650pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8651@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8652definitions of these labels are output using
8653@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8654way here. For example,
8655
8656@smallexample
8657fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8658 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8659@end smallexample
8660
8661You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8662dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8663will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8664@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8665mode and flags can be read.
8666@end defmac
8667
8668@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8669This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8670in a dispatch table are absolute.
8671
8672The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8673@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8674a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8675definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8676For example,
8677
8678@smallexample
8679fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8680@end smallexample
8681@end defmac
8682
8683@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8684Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8685specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8686@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8687jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8688@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8689
8690This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8691for the table.
8692
8693If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8694@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8695@end defmac
8696
8697@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8698Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8699jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8700after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8701the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8702@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8703of the preceding label.
8704
8705If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8706the jump-table.
8707@end defmac
8708
8709@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8710This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8711should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8712should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8713function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8714The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8715exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8716true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8717
8718The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8719@end deftypefn
8720
8721@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8722This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8723It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8724to be broken up according to function.
8725
8726The default is that no label is emitted.
8727@end deftypefn
8728
a68b5e52
RH
8729@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8730
38f8b050
JR
8731@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8732This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8733given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8734returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8735@end deftypefn
8736
3bc6b3e6
RH
8737@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8738
38f8b050
JR
8739@node Exception Region Output
8740@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8741
8742@c prevent bad page break with this line
8743
8744This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8745region.
8746
8747@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8748If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8749exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8750provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8751@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8752
8753You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8754unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8755@end defmac
8756
8757@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8758If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8759data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8760might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8761collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8762
8763Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8764also defined.
8765@end defmac
8766
8767@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8768Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8769information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8770runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8771and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8772@end defmac
8773
8774@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8775An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8776that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8777@end defmac
8778
8779@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8780Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8781information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8782Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8783@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8784or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8785@end defmac
38f8b050 8786
f0a0390e
RH
8787@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8788This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8789by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8790should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8791@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8792should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8793information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8794
f0a0390e
RH
8795A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8796This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8797default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8798
f0a0390e 8799Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8800not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8801@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8802setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8803macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8804depending on this setting.
8805
8806The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8807@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8808@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8809@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8810must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8811@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8812
8813@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8814This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8815tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8816command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8817@end deftypevr
8818
38f8b050
JR
8819@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8820Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8821should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8822instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8823@end defmac
8824
8825@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8826This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8827function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8828@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8829alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8830minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8831the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8832@end defmac
8833
8834@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8835Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8836end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8837Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8838true otherwise.
8839@end deftypevr
8840
8841@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8842Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8843represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8844register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8845locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8846register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8847If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8848@end deftypefn
8849
8850@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8851If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8852multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8853sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8854It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8855filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8856@var{address} is the address of the table.
8857@end deftypefn
8858
8859@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8860This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8861the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8862if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8863reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8864@end deftypefn
8865
8866@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8867This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8868based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8869the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8870running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8871@end deftypevr
8872
8873@node Alignment Output
8874@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8875
8876@c prevent bad page break with this line
8877This describes commands for alignment.
8878
8879@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8880The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8881a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8882
8883This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8884to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8885define the macro.
8886
8887Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8888to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8889@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8890selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8891@end defmac
8892
ad0c4c36
DD
8893@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8894The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8895@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8896@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8897@end deftypefn
8898
38f8b050
JR
8899@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8900The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8901a @code{BARRIER}.
8902
8903This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8904to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8905define the macro.
8906@end defmac
8907
ad0c4c36
DD
8908@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8909The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8910@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8911@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8912@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8913
8914@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8915The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8916a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8917
8918This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8919to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8920define the macro.
8921
8922Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8923to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8924@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8925selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8926@end defmac
8927
ad0c4c36
DD
8928@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8929The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8930@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8931defined.
8932@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8933
8934@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8935The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8936If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8937the maximum of the specified values is used.
8938
8939Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8940to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8941@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8942selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8943@end defmac
8944
ad0c4c36
DD
8945@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8946The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8947to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8948is defined.
8949@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8950
8951@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8952A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8953instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8954Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8955expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8956@end defmac
8957
8958@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8959Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8960text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8961This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8962produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8963section.
8964@end defmac
8965
8966@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8967A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8968command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8969@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8970@end defmac
8971
8972@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8973Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8974for padding, if necessary.
8975@end defmac
8976
8977@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8978A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8979command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8980@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8981satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8982a C expression of type @code{int}.
8983@end defmac
8984
8985@need 3000
8986@node Debugging Info
8987@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8988
8989@c prevent bad page break with this line
8990This describes how to specify debugging information.
8991
8992@menu
8993* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
8994* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
8995* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
8996* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
8997* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
8998* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
8999@end menu
9000
9001@node All Debuggers
9002@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9003
9004@c prevent bad page break with this line
9005These macros affect all debugging formats.
9006
9007@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9008A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9009register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9010of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9011some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9012versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9013compiler and another for DBX@.
9014
9015If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9016used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9017consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9018Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9019expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9020
9021If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9022does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9023redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9024@end defmac
9025
9026@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9027A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9028variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9029computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9030gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9031that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9032for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9033@option{-g} options is used.
9034@end defmac
9035
9036@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9037A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9038having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9039@var{offset}.
9040@end defmac
9041
9042@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9043A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9044produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9045this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9046debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9047@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9048@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9049
9050When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9051value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9052exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9053value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9054defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9055
9056The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9057user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9058@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9059@end defmac
9060
9061@node DBX Options
9062@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9063
9064@c prevent bad page break with this line
9065These are specific options for DBX output.
9066
9067@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9068Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9069in response to the @option{-g} option.
9070@end defmac
9071
9072@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9073Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9074in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9075@end defmac
9076
9077@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9078Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9079GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9080debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9081macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9082if there is any occasion to.
9083@end defmac
9084
9085@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9086Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9087in the text section.
9088@end defmac
9089
9090@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9091A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9092use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9093If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9094applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9095@end defmac
9096
9097@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9098A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9099use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9100value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9101@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9102information format.
9103@end defmac
9104
9105@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9106A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9107use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9108name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9109macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9110@end defmac
9111
9112@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9113Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9114@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9115describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9116On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9120A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9121continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9122exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9123operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9124must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9125with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9126defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9127@end defmac
9128
9129@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9130Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9131the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9132a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9133constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9134if backslash is correct for your system.
9135@end defmac
9136
9137@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9138Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9139outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9140variable.
9141@end defmac
9142
9143@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9144The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9145for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9146@end defmac
9147
9148@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9149The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9150for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9151provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9152@end defmac
9153
9154@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9155The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9156for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9157``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9158@end defmac
9159
9160@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9161The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9162passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9163do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9164@end defmac
9165
9166@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9167Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9168arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9169in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9170code.
9171@end defmac
9172
9173@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9174Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9175the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9176relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9177an absolute address.
9178@end defmac
9179
9180@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9181Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9182the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9183start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9184@end defmac
9185
9186@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9187Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9188@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9189macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9190number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9191generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9192number for a type number.
9193@end defmac
9194
9195@node DBX Hooks
9196@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9197
9198@c prevent bad page break with this line
9199These are hooks for DBX format.
9200
9201@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9202Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9203information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9204argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9205@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9206@end defmac
9207
9208@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9209Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9210@end defmac
9211
9212@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9213Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9214output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9215@end defmac
9216
9217@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9218A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9219number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9220@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9221invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9222unique labels in the assembly output.
9223
9224This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9225if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9226@end defmac
9227
9228@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9229Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9230@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9231On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9232disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9233@end defmac
9234
9235@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9236Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9237extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9238feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9239@end defmac
9240
9241@node File Names and DBX
9242@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9243
9244@c prevent bad page break with this line
9245This describes file names in DBX format.
9246
9247@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9248A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9249@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9250file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9251This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9252
9253This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9254for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9255
9256It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9257text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9258to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9259@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9260@end defmac
9261
9262@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9263Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9264of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9265the beginning of the file.
9266@end defmac
9267
9268@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9269Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9270that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9271an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9272@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9273@end defmac
9274
9275@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9276A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9277compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9278written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9279
9280If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9281of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9282@end defmac
9283
9284@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9285Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9286@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9287the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9288whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9289@end defmac
9290
9291@need 2000
9292@node SDB and DWARF
9293@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9294
9295@c prevent bad page break with this line
9296Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9297
9298@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9299Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9300for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9301@end defmac
9302
9303@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9304Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9305debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9306
9307@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9308Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9309be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9310value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9311@end deftypefn
9312
9313To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9314define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9315@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9316prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9317as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9318@end defmac
9319
9320@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9321Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9322Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9323(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9324exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9325how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9326@end defmac
9327
f0a0390e
RH
9328@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9329This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9330unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9331@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9332return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9333
9334A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9335is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9336
9337A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9338This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9339@end deftypefn
9340
38f8b050
JR
9341@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9342Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9343line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9344tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9345@end defmac
9346
9730bc27
TT
9347@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9348
2ba42841
AO
9349@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9350
9351@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9352
38f8b050
JR
9353@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9354A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9355@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9356@end defmac
9357
9358@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9361slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9362@end defmac
9363
9364@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9365A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9366section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9367given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9368@end defmac
9369
9370@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9371A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9372reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9373@end defmac
9374
9375@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9376A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9377the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9378is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9379is referenced by a function.
9380@end defmac
9381
9382@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9383If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9384reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9385@end deftypefn
9386
9387@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9388Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9389SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9390macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9391not define them yourself.
9392@end defmac
9393
9394@defmac SDB_DELIM
9395Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9396SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9397delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9398a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9399required.
9400@end defmac
9401
9402@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9403Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9404union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9405allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9406it.
9407@end defmac
9408
9409@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9410Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9411enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9412assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9413@end defmac
9414
9415@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9416A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9417number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9418@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9419@end defmac
9420
9421@need 2000
9422@node VMS Debug
9423@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9424
9425@c prevent bad page break with this line
9426Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9427
9428@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9429Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9430in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9431is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9432@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9433behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9434@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@node Floating Point
9438@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9439@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9440@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9441
9442While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9443there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9444means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9445in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9446doing the compilation.
9447
9448Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9449range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9450the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9451safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9452the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9453emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9454target floating point formats are identical.
9455
9456The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9457use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9458floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9459their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9460
9461@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9462The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9463machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9464array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9465quantity.
9466@end defmac
9467
9468@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9469Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9470floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9471@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9472@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9473@end deftypefn
9474
9475@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9476Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9477@end deftypefn
9478
9479@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9480Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9481@end deftypefn
9482
9483@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9484Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9485@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9486@end deftypefn
9487
9488@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9489Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9490representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9491decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9492defined by the C language for both.
9493@end deftypefn
9494
9495@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9496Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9497@end deftypefn
9498
9499@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9500Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9501@end deftypefn
9502
9503@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9504Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9505@end deftypefn
9506
9507@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9508Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9509@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9510variable).
9511
9512The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9513following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9514@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9515
9516If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9517target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9518@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9519@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9520@end deftypefn
9521
9522@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9523Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9524@end deftypefn
9525
9526@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9527Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9528@end deftypefn
9529
9530@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9531Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9532return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9533appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9534precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9535@end deftypefn
9536
9537@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9538Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9539which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9540integral, it is truncated.
9541@end deftypefn
9542
9543@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9544Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9545into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9546value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9547@end deftypefn
9548
9549@node Mode Switching
9550@section Mode Switching Instructions
9551@cindex mode switching
9552The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9553
9554@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9555Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9556switching in an optimizing compilation.
9557
9558For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9559floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9560the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9561operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9562purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9563be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9564or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9565
9566You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9567which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9568return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9569If you define this macro, you also have to define
9570@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9571@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9572@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9573are optional.
9574@end defmac
9575
9576@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9577If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9578initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9579N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9580of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9581The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9582zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9583entity in question.
9584In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9585represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9586switch is needed / supplied.
9587@end defmac
9588
9589@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9590@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9591@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9592return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9593@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9594be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9595@end defmac
9596
9597@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9598If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9599mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9600different from the incoming mode).
9601@end defmac
9602
9603@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9604If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9605mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9606@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9607is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9608@end defmac
9609
9610@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9611If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9612mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9613@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9614is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9615@end defmac
9616
9617@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9618This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96190 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9620lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9621for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9622(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9623@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9624@end defmac
9625
9626@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9627Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9628@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9629the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9630@end defmac
9631
9632@node Target Attributes
9633@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9634@cindex target attributes
9635@cindex machine attributes
9636@cindex attributes, target-specific
9637
9638Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9639These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9640be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9641
9642@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9643If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9644attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9645specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9646entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9647take.
9648@end deftypevr
9649
9650@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9651If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9652machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9653given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9654subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9655false for all machine-specific attributes.
9656@end deftypefn
9657
9658@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9659If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9660@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9661and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9662generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9663supposed always to be compatible.
9664@end deftypefn
9665
9666@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9667If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9668the newly defined @var{type}.
9669@end deftypefn
9670
9671@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9672Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9673handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9674@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9675that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9676function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9677merging.
9678@end deftypefn
9679
9680@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9681Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9682handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9683@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9684@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9685when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9686attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9687call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9688
9689@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9690If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9691for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9692@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9693will then define a function called
9694@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9695the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9696add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9697to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9698@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9699@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9700@end deftypefn
9701
9702@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9703
9704@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9705Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9706@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9707default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9708@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9709of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9710on this implementation detail.
9711@end defmac
9712
9713@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9714Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9715when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9716wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9717the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9718created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9719for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9720shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9721the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9722attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9723needed.
9724@end deftypefn
9725
9726@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9727@cindex inlining
9728This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9729into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9730attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9731target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9732@end deftypefn
9733
9734@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9735This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9736it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9737options for the current function that might be different than the
9738options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9739@code{true} if the options are valid.
9740
9741The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9742the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9743@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9744@end deftypefn
9745
9746@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9747This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9748in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9749options.
9750@xref{Option file format}.
9751@end deftypefn
9752
9753@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9754This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9755information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9756function specific options.
9757@end deftypefn
9758
9759@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9760This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9761information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9762function specific options.
9763@end deftypefn
9764
56cb42ea 9765@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9766This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9767set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9768input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9769@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9770@end deftypefn
9771
9772@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9773Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9774a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9775@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9776once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9777
9778Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9779@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9780
9781If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9782changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9783@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9784@end deftypefn
9785
9786@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9787This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9788cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9789default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9790specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9791@end deftypefn
9792
9793@node Emulated TLS
9794@section Emulating TLS
9795@cindex Emulated TLS
9796
9797For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9798specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9799used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9800configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9801the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9802layer.
9803
9804The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9805object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9806which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9807address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9808
9809@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9810Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9811object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9812emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9813@end deftypevr
9814
9815@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9816Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9817program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9818initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9819have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9820registration function to be used.
9821@end deftypevr
9822
9823@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9824Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9825be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9826any section.
9827@end deftypevr
9828
9829@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9830Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9831placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9832section.
9833@end deftypevr
9834
9835@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9836Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9837The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9838@end deftypevr
9839
9840@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9841Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9842default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9843@end deftypevr
9844
9845@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9846Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9847object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9848@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9849@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9850for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9851@end deftypefn
9852
9853@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9854Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9855TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9856is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9857initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9858@end deftypefn
9859
9860@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9861Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9862fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9863single objects. The default is false.
9864@end deftypevr
9865
9866@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9867Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9868may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9869@end deftypevr
9870
9871@node MIPS Coprocessors
9872@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9873@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9874
9875The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9876coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9877accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9878and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9879
9880@smallexample
9881 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9882 unsigned int d;
9883
9884 d = cp0count + 3;
9885@end smallexample
9886
9887(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9888names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9889overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9890
9891Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9892be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9893later in the function.
9894
9895Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9896the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9897floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9898
9899There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9900you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9901
9902@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9903A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9904alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9905@smallexample
9906@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9907@end smallexample
9908Default: empty.
9909@end defmac
9910
9911@node PCH Target
9912@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9913@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9914
9915@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9916This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9917@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9918@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9919@end deftypefn
9920
9921@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9922This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9923compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9924if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9925be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9926
9927@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9928when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9929It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9930compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9931
9932The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9933suitable for most targets.
9934@end deftypefn
9935
9936@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9937If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9938@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9939of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9940@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9941value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9942@end deftypefn
9943
9944@node C++ ABI
9945@section C++ ABI parameters
9946@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9947
9948@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9949Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9950These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9951default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9952@end deftypefn
9953
9954@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9955This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9956@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9957@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9958@end deftypefn
9959
9960@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9961This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9962whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9963known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9964@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9965IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9966@end deftypefn
9967
9968@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9969This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9970array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9971@end deftypefn
9972
9973@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9974If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9975class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9976will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9977to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9978modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9979backend's targeted operating system.
9980@end deftypefn
9981
9982@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9983This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9984the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9985@code{false}.
9986@end deftypefn
9987
9988@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9989This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9990which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9991table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9992Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9993the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9994some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9995method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9996@end deftypefn
9997
9998@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9999
10000@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10001This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10002similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10003external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10004classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10005unit will not be COMDAT.
10006@end deftypefn
10007
10008@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10009This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10010the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10011be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10012@end deftypefn
10013
10014@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10015This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10016should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10017is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10018@end deftypefn
10019
10020@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10021This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10022in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10023destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10024shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10025unloaded. The default is to return false.
10026@end deftypefn
10027
10028@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10029
10030@node Named Address Spaces
10031@section Adding support for named address spaces
10032@cindex named address spaces
10033
10034The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10035standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10036support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10037processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10038GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10039address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10040spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10041@code{const} type attributes.
10042
10043Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10044pointers to the generic address space.
10045
10046For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10047to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10048processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10049issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10050local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10051address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10052@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10053always 32 bits).
10054
10055Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10056range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10057address space.
10058
10059To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10060the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10061the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10062named address space #1:
10063@smallexample
10064#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10065c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10066@end smallexample
10067
10068@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10069Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10070@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10071The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10072generic address space only.
10073@end deftypefn
10074
10075@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10076Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10077@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10078The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10079generic address space only.
10080@end deftypefn
10081
10082@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10083Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10084with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10085hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10086except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10087version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10088@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10089target hooks for the given address space.
10090@end deftypefn
10091
10092@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10093Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10094@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10095parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10096finished. This target hook is the same as the
10097@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10098explicit named address space support.
10099@end deftypefn
10100
10101@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10102Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10103with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10104hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10105except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10106@end deftypefn
10107
10108@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10109Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10110contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10111a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10112will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10113arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10114converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10115@end deftypefn
10116
10117@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10118Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10119@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10120space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10121to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10122guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10123as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10124@end deftypefn
10125
10126@node Misc
10127@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10128@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10129
10130@c prevent bad page break with this line
10131Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10132
10133@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10134Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10135has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10136conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10137blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10138set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10139to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10140@end defmac
10141
10142@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10143Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10144has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10145conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10146blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10147set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10148to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10149@end defmac
10150
10151@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10152An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10153elements of a jump-table should have.
10154@end defmac
10155
10156@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10157Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10158when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10159it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10160To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10161make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10162The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10163flags can be updated.
10164@end defmac
10165
10166@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10167Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10168should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10169jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10170contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10171is in effect.
10172@end defmac
10173
10174@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10175This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10176is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10177The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10178five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10179@end deftypefn
10180
10181@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10182Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10183statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10184advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10185of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10186targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10187@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10188@code{false} otherwise.
10189@end defmac
10190
10191@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10192Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10193smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10194Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10195@end defmac
10196
10197@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10198Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10199memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10200bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10201zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10202of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10203insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10204@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10205
10206This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10207greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10208value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10209@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10210define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10211
10212You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10213the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10214of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10215when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10216integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10217
10218You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10219mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10220@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10221is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10222@end defmac
10223
10224@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10225Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10226extends.
10227@end defmac
10228
10229@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10230Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10231point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10232unsigned one.
10233@end defmac
10234
10235@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10236When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10237divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10238the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10239that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10240of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10241has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10242@end deftypefn
10243
10244@defmac MOVE_MAX
10245The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10246between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10247@end defmac
10248
10249@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10250The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10251between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10252is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10253constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10254at run-time.
10255@end defmac
10256
10257@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10258A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10259actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10260of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10261this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10262a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10263truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10264instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10265include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10266also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10267arguments to bit-field instructions.
10268
10269If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10270position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10271instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10272
10273However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10274only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10275bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10276such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10277the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10278
10279You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10280@end defmac
10281
10282@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10283@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10284This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10285deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10286@xref{shift patterns}.
10287
10288On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10289shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10290equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10291this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10292otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10293particular behavior is guaranteed.
10294
10295Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10296@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10297that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10298
10299The default implementation of this function returns
10300@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10301and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10302@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10303nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10304by overriding it.
10305@end deftypefn
10306
10307@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10308A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10309``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10310bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10311operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10312
10313On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10314
10315@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10316@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10317When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10318modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10319If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10320such cases may improve things.
10321@end defmac
10322
10323@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10324The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10325are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10326@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10327sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10328otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10329representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10330@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10331@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10332@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10333widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10334
10335Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10336value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10337as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10338@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10339
10340Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10341describe two related properties. If you define
10342@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10343to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10344extension.
10345
10346In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10347@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10348@code{mode}.
10349@end deftypefn
10350
10351@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10352A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10353with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10354(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10355apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10356comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10357
10358A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10359comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10360and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10361which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10362true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10363operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10364@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10365@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10366the compiler.
10367
10368If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10369generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10370replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10371the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10372For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10373@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10374@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10375expression
10376
10377@smallexample
10378(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10379@end smallexample
10380
10381@noindent
10382can be converted to
10383
10384@smallexample
10385(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10386@end smallexample
10387
10388@noindent
10389where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10390tested into the sign bit.
10391
10392There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10393for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10394but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10395are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10396perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10397comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10398
10399Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10400from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10401choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10402to be used:
10403
10404@itemize @bullet
10405@item
10406Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10407@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10408``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10409comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10410combine the normalization with other operations.
10411
10412@item
10413For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10414slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10415other machines.
10416
10417@item
10418As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10419exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10420others.
10421
10422@item
10423Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10424@end itemize
10425
10426Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10427@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10428instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10429those cases, e.g., one matching
10430
10431@smallexample
10432(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10433@end smallexample
10434
10435Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10436condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10437@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10438machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10439and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10440@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10441@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10442find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10443
10444If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10445not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10446instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10447@end defmac
10448
10449@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10450A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10451returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10452Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10453floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10454this macro.
10455@end defmac
10456
10457@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10458A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10459for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10460mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10461this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10462return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10463this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10464@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10465the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10466given mode.
10467@end defmac
10468
10469@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10470@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10471A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10472for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
38f8b050
JR
10473A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10474If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10475evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10476entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10477the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
38f8b050 10478In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10479this value.
38f8b050
JR
10480
10481If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10482@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10483
10484This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10485relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10486is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10487to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10488
10489Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10490and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10491visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10492to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10493breaking the API@.
10494@end defmac
10495
10496@defmac Pmode
10497An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10498this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10499pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10500On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10501modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10502
10503The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10504@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10505@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10506to @code{Pmode}.
10507@end defmac
10508
10509@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10510An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10511being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10512where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
38f8b050
JR
10513@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10514size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10515as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10516@end defmac
10517
10518@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10519In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10520constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10521hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10522where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10523strict conformance to the C Standard.
10524
10525Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10526convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10527files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10528@end defmac
10529
10530@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10531Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10532This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10533C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10534@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10535@end defmac
10536
10537@findex #pragma
10538@findex pragma
10539@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10540Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10541If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10542@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10543for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10544setup required for the pragmas.
10545
10546The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10547other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10548definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10549
10550If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10551defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10552
10553Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10554@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10555silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10556@end defmac
10557
10558@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10559@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10560
10561Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10562@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10563@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10564pragma of the form
10565
10566@smallexample
10567#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10568@end smallexample
10569
10570@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10571@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10572routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10573on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10574@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10575callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10576a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10577arguments of pragmas registered with
10578@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10579pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10580
10581Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10582compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10583other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10584to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10585building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10586variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10587target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10588the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10589code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10590rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10591how to build this object file.
10592@end deftypefun
10593
38f8b050 10594@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10595Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10596arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10597@end defmac
10598
10599@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10600
10601@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10602If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10603the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10604This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10605@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10606@end defmac
10607
10608@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10609Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10610identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10611not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10612there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10613@end defmac
10614
10615@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10616Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10617@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10618G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10619@samp{.} is used instead.
10620@end defmac
10621
10622@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10623Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10624@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10625have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10626are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10627@end defmac
10628
10629@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10630Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10631delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10632even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10633@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10634every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10635or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10636you should define this macro.
10637
10638You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10639@end defmac
10640
10641@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10642Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10643delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10644even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10645@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10646some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10647are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10648define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10649instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10650slot of @var{insn}.
10651
10652You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10653@end defmac
10654
10655@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10656Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10657global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10658symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10659instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10660from shared libraries (DLLs).
10661
10662You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10663@end defmac
10664
10665@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10666This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10667any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10668It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10669clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10670corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10671clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10672@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10673for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10674@end deftypefn
10675
10676@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10677Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10678in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10679@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10680separate math library.
10681
d9d16a19 10682You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10683@end defmac
10684
10685@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10686Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10687specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10688
10689You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10690is wrong.
10691@end defmac
10692
10693@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10694Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10695functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10696Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10697to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10698if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10699for cross-profiling.
10700@end defmac
10701
10702@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10703
10704A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10705conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10706@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107071 if it does use cc0.
10708@end defmac
10709
10710@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10711Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10712conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10713@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10714contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10715and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10716then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10717@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10718@end defmac
10719
10720@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10721Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10722if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10723@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10724being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10725@end defmac
10726
10727@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10728A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10729be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10730a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10731about the currently processed blocks.
10732@end defmac
10733
10734@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10735A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10736converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10737can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10738to by @var{ce_info}.
10739@end defmac
10740
10741@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10742A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10743converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10744can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10745to by @var{ce_info}.
10746@end defmac
10747
10748@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10749A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10750structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10751@end defmac
10752
10753@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10754If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10755added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10756by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10757@end defmac
10758
10759@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10760If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10761instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10762just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10763
10764The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10765it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10766laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10767Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10768
10769You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10770definition is null.
10771@end deftypefn
10772
10773@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10774Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10775that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10776necessary setup.
10777
10778Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10779instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10780they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10781instructions or prefetch instructions).
10782
10783To create a built-in function, call the function
10784@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10785which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10786up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
38f8b050
JR
10787only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10788@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10789@end deftypefn
10790
10791@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10792Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10793that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10794builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10795If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10796if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10797If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10798@code{error_mark_node}.
10799@end deftypefn
10800
10801@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10802
10803Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10804@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10805function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10806convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10807@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10808@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10809ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10810built-in function.
10811@end deftypefn
10812
d66f5459 10813@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10814Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10815was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10816@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10817implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10818declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10819arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10820complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10821another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10822@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10823@end deftypefn
10824
08914aaa 10825@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10826Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10827@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10828built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10829the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10830The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10831call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10832@end deftypefn
10833
10834@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10835
10836Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10837low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10838could not be applied.
10839
10840Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10841instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10842the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10843By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10844loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10845@end deftypefn
10846
10847@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10848
10849Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10850Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10851@var{branch2} is possible.
10852
10853On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10854filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10855may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10856@end defmac
10857
10858@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10859This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10860Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10861PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10862of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10863@end deftypefn
10864
10865@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10866
10867When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10868register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10869to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10870it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10871is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10872that had its initial value copied by using
10873@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10874Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10875to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10876the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10877@code{MEM}.
10878If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10879it might decide to use another register anyways.
10880You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10881that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10882register in question will not be clobbered.
10883The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10884allocation.
10885@end deftypefn
10886
10887@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10888This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10889@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10890this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10891@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10892to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10893passed along.
10894@end deftypefn
10895
10896@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
ff2ce160 10897The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
38f8b050
JR
10898context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10899the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10900per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10901attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10902The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10903and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10904and is returning to processing at the top level.
10905The default hook function does nothing.
10906
10907GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10908some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10909situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10910or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10911@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10912outside of any function scope.
10913@end deftypefn
10914
10915@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10916Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10917files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10918use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10919@end defmac
10920
10921@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10922Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10923automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10924do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10925executable files.
10926@end defmac
10927
10928@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10929If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10930specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10931Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10932object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10933lists.
10934@end defmac
10935
10936@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10937Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10938method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10939must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10940For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10941the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10942defined as this expression:
10943
10944@smallexample
10945build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10946 build_tree_list
10947 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10948 NULL))
10949@end smallexample
10950@end defmac
10951
10952@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10953This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10954instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10955every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10956reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10957
10958@smallexample
10959static bool
10960cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10961@{
10962 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10963@}
10964@end smallexample
10965@end deftypefn
10966
10967@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10968This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10969optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10970usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10971re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10972to inter-block scheduling.
10973@end deftypefn
10974
10975@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10976Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10977registers
10978that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10979returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10980that all target registers in the class returned by
10981@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10982saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10983epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10984true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10985to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10986to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10987@end deftypefn
10988
10989@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10990This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10991This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10992modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10993@end deftypefn
10994
10995@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10996This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10997should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10998the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10999the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11000is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11001number of memory accesses.
11002@end deftypefn
11003
11004@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11005If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11006that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11007that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11008constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11009more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11010system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11011The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11012@end defmac
11013
11014@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11015This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11016target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11017are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11018The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11019@end deftypefn
11020
11021@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11022This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11023target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11024indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11025@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11026@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11027@end deftypefn
11028
11029@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11030This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11031The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11032systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11033that are different from @option{-I}.
11034@end deftypefn
11035
11036@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11037This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11038for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11039@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11040functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11041@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11042@end defmac
11043
11044@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11045If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11046target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11047option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11048@end defmac
11049
11050@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11051If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11052@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11053@end defmac
11054
11055@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11056If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11057target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11058default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11059@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11060@end defmac
11061
11062@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11063If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11064@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11065@end defmac
11066
11067@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11068If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11069routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11070and scanf formatter settings.
11071@end defmac
11072
11073@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11074If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11075guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11076main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11077important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11078many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11079``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11080and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11081@end deftypevr
11082
11083@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11084If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11085illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11086with prototype @var{typelist}.
11087@end deftypefn
11088
11089@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11090If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11091invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11092if validity should be determined by the front end.
11093@end deftypefn
11094
11095@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11096If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11097invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11098@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11099if validity should be determined by the front end.
11100@end deftypefn
11101
11102@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11103If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11104invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11105and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11106the front end.
11107@end deftypefn
11108
11109@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11110If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11111invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11112or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11113the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11114@end deftypefn
11115
11116@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11117If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11118invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11119or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11120the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11121@end deftypefn
11122
11123@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11124If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11125@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
38f8b050
JR
11126analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11127front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11128target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11129This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11130@end deftypefn
11131
11132@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11133If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11134@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
38f8b050 11135or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11136This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
38f8b050
JR
11137conversion rules.
11138This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11139@end deftypefn
11140
11141@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11142This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11143classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11144SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11145@end defmac
11146
11147@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11148This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11149NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11150@end defmac
11151
11152@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11153Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11154to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
38f8b050
JR
11155call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11156and the associated definitions of those functions.
11157@end defmac
11158
11159@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11160Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11161necessary.
11162@end deftypefn
11163
11164@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11165This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11166different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11167argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11168is needed.
11169@end deftypefn
11170
11171@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11172When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11173arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11174stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11175debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11176@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11177cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11178to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11179false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11180@end deftypefn
11181
11182@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11183On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11184a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11185is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11186is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11187subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11188the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11189available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11190constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11191down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11192@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11193accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11194value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11195MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11196@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11197is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
This page took 1.508342 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.